2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
\input texinfo
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@c %**start of header
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@setfilename ../../info/org
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@settitle The Org Manual
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2009-01-07 07:27:02 -05:00
@set VERSION 6.17trans
2009-01-04 03:00:34 -05:00
@set DATE January 2009
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@dircategory Emacs
@direntry
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end direntry
@c Version and Contact Info
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
@set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@c %**end of header
@finalout
@c Macro definitions
2008-01-31 05:31:03 -05:00
@c Subheadings inside a table.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@macro tsubheading{text}
@ifinfo
@subsubheading \text\
@end ifinfo
@ifnotinfo
@item @b{\text\}
@end ifnotinfo
@end macro
@copying
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
This manual is for Org (version @value{VERSION}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@quotation
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
2008-11-24 06:21:40 -05:00
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
2008-06-15 00:45:12 -04:00
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
2008-09-10 05:10:21 -04:00
and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
2008-06-17 11:05:23 -04:00
(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end quotation
@end copying
@titlepage
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@title The Org Manual
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
@author by Carsten Dominik
@c The following two commands start the copyright page.
@page
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
@insertcopying
@end titlepage
@c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
@contents
@ifnottex
@node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
@top Org Mode Manual
@insertcopying
@end ifnottex
@menu
* Introduction:: Getting started
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
* Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
* Capture:: Creating tasks and attaching files
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX fragments and formulas
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
* Extensions:: Add-ons for Org mode
* Hacking:: How hack your way around
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
@detailmenu
--- The Detailed Node Listing ---
Introduction
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
* Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Archiving
* ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Tables
* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
* Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
* Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
The spreadsheet
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
* References:: How to refer to another field or range
* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
Hyperlinks
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
* External links:: URL-like links to the world
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Internal links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
TODO Items
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Extended use of TODO keywords
* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Progress logging
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
Tags
* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
Properties and Columns
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Property searches:: Matching property values
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Defining columns
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
Dates and Times
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
Creating timestamps
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Deadlines and scheduling
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
Capture
* Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
* Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
Remember
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
* Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
Agenda Views
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
2008-04-15 05:02:10 -04:00
* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
The built-in agenda views
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
* Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
Presentation and sorting
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
Custom agenda views
* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
* Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Embedded LaTeX
* Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
* Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Exporting
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Export options:: Per-file export settings
* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
* ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Markup rules
* Document title:: How the document title is determined
* Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
* Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
* Initial text:: Text before the first headline
* Lists:: Plain lists are exported
* Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
* Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
* Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
* Footnote markup::
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
* TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
* Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
* Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
HTML export
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Images in HTML export::
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
* Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
LaTeX and PDF export
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invode which commands
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Publishing
* Configuration:: Defining projects
* Sample configuration:: Example projects
* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
Configuration
* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
Sample configuration
* Simple example:: One-component publishing
* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Miscellaneous
* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
* Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Interaction with other packages
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
Extensions
* Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
* Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
Hacking
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
* Special agenda views:: Customized views
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end detailmenu
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Introduction
@cindex introduction
@menu
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Summary
@cindex summary
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
time stamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
linked web pages.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
An important design aspect that distinguishes Org from for example
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
Planner/Muse is that it encourages to store every piece of information
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org,
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks,
label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists like a
schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by
tags etc are created dynamically when you need them.
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
example as:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@r{@bullet{} outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
@r{@bullet{} ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
@r{@bullet{} ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities}
@r{@bullet{} TODO list editor}
@r{@bullet{} full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
@r{@bullet{} environment to implement David Allen's GTD system}
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@r{@bullet{} a basic database application}
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@r{@bullet{} simple hypertext system, with HTML and LaTeX export}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@r{@bullet{} publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org's automatic, context sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
the minor Orgstruct mode.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex FAQ
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
questions (FAQ), links to tutorials etc. This page is located at
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@uref{http://orgmode.org}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@page
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
@section Installation
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex installation
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@cindex XEmacs
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@b{Important:} @i{If Org is part of the Emacs distribution or an
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@ref{Activation}.}
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
or @file{.tar} file, or as a GIT archive, you must take the following steps
to install it: Go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@example
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
@end example
@noindent
2008-04-07 11:36:12 -04:00
If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
step for this directory:
@example
2008-04-07 11:36:12 -04:00
(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@end example
@b{XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
command:}
@example
@b{make install-noutline}
@end example
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
@noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@example
make
@end example
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
@noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
all. If you want to install into the system directories, use
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@example
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
make install
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
make install-info
@end example
@noindent Then add to @file{.emacs}:
@lisp
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
;; This line only if Org is not part of the X/Emacs distribution.
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
(require 'org-install)
@end lisp
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
@section Activation
@cindex activation
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex autoload
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@cindex global key bindings
@cindex key bindings, global
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@iftex
@b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy lisp code from the
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
PDF documentation as viewed by some PDF viewers to your .emacs file, the
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
single quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work.
You need to fix the single quotes by hand, or copy from Info
documentation.}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@end iftex
2008-10-24 17:04:18 -04:00
Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
2008-04-14 01:47:32 -04:00
define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
@command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} - please choose suitable
keys yourself.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@lisp
;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
2008-01-31 05:35:36 -05:00
(add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
(global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
(global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
2008-04-14 01:47:32 -04:00
(global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
(XEmacs user must use the second option):
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@lisp
(global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Org mode, turning on
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
like this:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
the file's name is. See also the variable
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
@code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
Many commands in Org work on the region is he region is active. To make use
of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode} (@code{zmacs-regions} in
XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default, in Emacs 22 you need to
do this yourself with
@lisp
(transient-mark-mode 1)
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Feedback
@cindex feedback
@cindex bug reports
@cindex maintainer
@cindex author
2008-05-28 17:59:35 -04:00
If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
2008-05-30 00:02:51 -04:00
about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
2008-05-28 17:59:35 -04:00
If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be reviewed by a
moderator and then passed through to the list.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible,
including the version information of Emacs (@kbd{C-h v emacs-version
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@key{RET}}) and Org (@kbd{C-h v org-version @key{RET}}), as well as
the Org related setup in @file{.emacs}. If an error occurs, a
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to create one). Often a
small example file helps, along with clear information about:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@enumerate
@item What exactly did you do?
@item What did you expect to happen?
@item What happened instead?
@end enumerate
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
@noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
@subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
@cindex backtrace of an error
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{Backtrace}.
This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
@enumerate
@item
Start a fresh Emacs or XEmacs, and make sure that it will load the
original Lisp code in @file{org.el} instead of the compiled version in
@file{org.elc}. The backtrace contains much more information if it is
produced with uncompiled code. To do this, either rename @file{org.elc}
to something else before starting Emacs, or ask Emacs explicitly to load
@file{org.el} by using the command line
@example
emacs -l /path/to/org.el
@end example
@item
Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
(XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
document the steps you take.
@item
When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
attach it to your bug report.
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
@end enumerate
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
@section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@table @code
@item TODO
@itemx WAITING
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
user-defined.
@item boss
@itemx ARCHIVE
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
meaning are written with all capitals.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item Release
@itemx PRIORITY
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
special meaning are written with all capitals.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Document Structure
@cindex document structure
@cindex structure of document
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org is based on outline mode and provides flexible commands to
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
edit the structure of the document.
@menu
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
* Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Outlines
@cindex outlines
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Outline mode
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
document to show only the general document structure and the parts
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
command @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Headlines
@cindex headlines
@cindex outline tree
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior
of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
* Top level headline
** Second level
*** 3rd level
some text
*** 3rd level
more text
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Another top level headline
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
starters. @ref{Clean view} describes a setup to realize this.
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Visibility cycling
@cindex cycling, visibility
@cindex visibility cycling
@cindex trees, visibility
@cindex show hidden text
@cindex hide text
Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex subtree visibility states
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@cindex subtree cycling
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex folded, subtree visibility state
@cindex children, subtree visibility state
@cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
@table @kbd
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item @key{TAB}
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
'-----------------------------------'
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
@key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex global visibility states
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@cindex global cycling
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex overview, global visibility state
@cindex contents, global visibility state
@cindex show all, global visibility state
@kindex S-@key{TAB}
@item S-@key{TAB}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@itemx C-u @key{TAB}
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
'--------------------------------------'
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex show all, command
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
@kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
@item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
Show all, including drawers.
2008-01-31 05:32:56 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-r
@item C-c C-r
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
(@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
level, all sibling headings.
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x b
@item C-c C-x b
Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
buffer
@ifinfo
(@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
@end ifinfo
@ifnotinfo
(see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
@end ifnotinfo
will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
the previously used indirect buffer.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
buffer:
@example
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
#+STARTUP: overview
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
#+STARTUP: content
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
#+STARTUP: showall
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-05-08 08:32:10 -04:00
@noindent
Forthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
@code{all}.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
@item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
entries.
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Motion
@cindex motion, between headlines
@cindex jumping, to headlines
@cindex headline navigation
The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-n
@item C-c C-n
Next heading.
@kindex C-c C-p
@item C-c C-p
Previous heading.
@kindex C-c C-f
@item C-c C-f
Next heading same level.
@kindex C-c C-b
@item C-c C-b
Previous heading same level.
@kindex C-c C-u
@item C-c C-u
Backward to higher level heading.
@kindex C-c C-j
@item C-c C-j
Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
you can use the following keys to find your destination:
@example
@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
2008-10-24 17:01:58 -04:00
@key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
@kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
@r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
u @r{One level up.}
0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
2008-10-24 17:01:58 -04:00
q @r{Quit}
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
@end example
2008-11-24 04:59:10 -05:00
See also the variable@code{org-goto-interface}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Structure editing, Archiving, Motion, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Structure editing
@cindex structure editing
@cindex headline, promotion and demotion
@cindex promotion, of subtrees
@cindex demotion, of subtrees
@cindex subtree, cut and paste
@cindex pasting, of subtrees
@cindex cutting, of subtrees
@cindex copying, of subtrees
@cindex subtrees, cut and paste
@table @kbd
@kindex M-@key{RET}
@item M-@key{RET}
Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
2008-02-22 06:01:03 -05:00
the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
after the end of the subtree.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@kindex C-@key{RET}
@item C-@key{RET}
2008-10-22 01:53:22 -04:00
Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
@item M-S-@key{RET}
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading.
2008-09-13 13:22:33 -04:00
@kindex C-S-@key{RET}
@item C-S-@key{RET}
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
@kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
subtree.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{left}
@item M-@key{left}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Promote current heading by one level.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{right}
@item M-@key{right}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Demote current heading by one level.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
@item M-S-@key{left}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Promote the current subtree by one level.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
@item M-S-@key{right}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Demote the current subtree by one level.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
@item M-S-@key{up}
Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
level).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
@item M-S-@key{down}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-w
@item C-c C-x C-w
Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x M-w
@item C-c C-x M-w
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
sequential subtrees.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-y
@item C-c C-x C-y
Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
headline marker like @samp{****}.
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@kindex C-y
2008-10-27 12:57:53 -04:00
@item C-y
Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
@code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
2008-11-11 03:25:10 -05:00
C-x C-y}. With the default settings, level adjustment will take place and
yanked trees will be folded unless doing so would swallow text previously
visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal @code{yank}
to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal
2008-11-14 01:47:32 -05:00
yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a yank, it will yank
previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-w
@item C-c C-w
2008-11-10 16:17:57 -05:00
Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
2008-01-31 05:33:09 -05:00
@kindex C-c ^
@item C-c ^
2008-04-10 02:27:56 -04:00
Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
alphabetically, numerically, by time (using the first time stamp in each
entry), by priority, or by TODO keyword (in the sequence the keywords have
been defined in the setup). Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can
also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u}
prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes,
duplicate entries will also be removed.
2008-06-12 09:07:32 -04:00
@kindex C-x n s
@item C-x n s
Narrow buffer to current subtree.
@kindex C-x n w
@item C-x n w
Widen buffer to remove a narrowing.
2008-03-03 05:56:51 -05:00
@kindex C-c *
@item C-c *
Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it
becomes a subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a
normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn
all lines in the region into headlines. Or, if the first line is a
headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
@cindex region, active
@cindex active region
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Transient mark mode
When there is an active region (Transient mark mode), promotion and
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
functionality.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Archiving, Sparse trees, Structure editing, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Archiving
@cindex archiving
When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
agenda. Org mode knows two ways of archiving. You can mark a tree with
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
the ARCHIVE tag, or you can move an entire (sub)tree to a different
location.
@menu
* ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
@end menu
@node ARCHIVE tag, Moving subtrees, Archiving, Archiving
@subsection The ARCHIVE tag
@cindex internal archiving
A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
@itemize @minus
@item
It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
@code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
@code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
@code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
@item
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
2008-06-19 18:20:12 -04:00
@code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
be included. In the agenda you can press the @kbd{v} key to get archives
temporarily included.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
is. Configure the details using the variable
@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag:
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-x a
@item C-c C-x a
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
hidden.
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-x a
@item C-u C-c C-x a
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
level 1 trees will be checked.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
@item C-@kbd{TAB}
Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@end table
@node Moving subtrees, , ARCHIVE tag, Archiving
@subsection Moving subtrees
@cindex external archiving
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
Once an entire project is finished, you may want to move it to a different
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
location. Org can move it to an @emph{Archive Sibling} in the same tree, to a
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
different tree in the current file, or to a different file, the archive file.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-x A
@item C-c C-x A
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
(@pxref{ARCHIVE tag}). The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this
way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags and
approximate position in the outline.
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-s
@item C-c C-x C-s
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
given by @code{org-archive-location}. Context information that could be
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
lost like the file name, the category, inherited tags, and the TODO
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
state will be store as properties in the entry.
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
@item C-u C-c C-x C-s
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
@cindex archive locations
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
see the documentation string of the variable
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
2009-01-11 15:23:10 -05:00
setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@example
#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
@end example
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
record context information like the file from where the entry came, it's
outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
@code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
added.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Archiving, Document Structure
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Sparse trees
@cindex sparse trees
@cindex trees, sparse
@cindex folding, sparse trees
@cindex occur, command
2008-05-27 04:14:11 -04:00
An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
@code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
and you will see immediately how it works.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c /
@item C-c /
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
@kindex C-c / r
@item C-c / r
2008-06-12 10:31:13 -04:00
Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
editing command@footnote{depending on the option
@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
so several calls to this command can be stacked.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent
For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
For example:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex printing sparse trees
@cindex visible text, printing
To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
@code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
part of the document and print the resulting file.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@section Plain lists
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex plain lists
@cindex lists, plain
@cindex lists, ordered
@cindex ordered lists
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
@itemize @bullet
@item
@emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
@samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
@samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
as bullets.
@item
@emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}.
@item
@emph{Description} list items are like unordered list items, but contain the
separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
desciption.
@end itemize
Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
Here is an example:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@group
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
** Lord of the Rings
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1. The attack of the Rohirrim
2. Eowyns fight with the witch king
+ this was already my favorite scene in the book
+ I really like Miranda Otto.
3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
- on DVD only
He makes a really funny face when it happens.
But in the end, not individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
Important actors in this film are:
- @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays the Frodo
- @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays the Sam, Frodos friend. I still remember
him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh a in the Goonies.
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@end group
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to
deal with them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
settings for Emacs. For XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones'
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
@file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on, put into @file{.emacs}:
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
@code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them properly
(@pxref{Exporting}).
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item @key{TAB}
Items can be folded just like headline levels if you set the variable
@code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. The level of an item is then
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always
subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
completely separated.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{RET}
@item M-@key{RET}
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
@code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
@emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
@emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
@item M-S-@key{RET}
2008-01-31 05:32:13 -05:00
Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{up}
@kindex S-@key{down}
@item S-@key{up}
@itemx S-@key{down}
Jump to the previous/next item in the current list.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
@item M-S-@key{up}
@itemx M-S-@key{down}
Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
automatic.
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
@item M-S-@key{left}
@itemx M-S-@key{right}
Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:32:13 -05:00
If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c -
@item C-c -
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
(@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
converted into a list item.
2008-11-20 08:50:06 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
Also cycle bullet styles when in the first line of an item.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@node Drawers, Footnotes, Plain lists, Document Structure
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@section Drawers
@cindex drawers
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex visibility cycling, drawers
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
Drawers need to be configured with the variable
@code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
look like this:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@example
** This is a headline
Still outside the drawer
:DRAWERNAME:
This is inside the drawer.
:END:
After the drawer.
@end example
Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will
hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line.
In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
drawer line and press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses a drawer for
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and another one for
storing clock times (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Drawers, Document Structure
@section Footnotes
@cindex footnotes
Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
@file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
2008-12-31 12:22:46 -05:00
brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. The footnote reference is
simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@example
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
...
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
[fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@end example
Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
@file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
encouraged because of possible conflicts with LaTeX snippets @pxref{Embedded
LaTeX}. Here are the valid references:
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@table @code
@item [1]
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
A plain numeric footnote marker.
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@item [fn:name]
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
reference point.
@item [fn:name: a definition]
An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use use
@code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
@end table
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you create names yourself.
This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
for details.
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@noindent The following command handles footnotes:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x f
@item C-c C-x f
2009-01-03 03:03:04 -05:00
The footnote action command.
When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
2009-01-03 03:03:04 -05:00
definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
separately into the location determined by the variable
@code{org-footnote-section}.
When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
options is offered:
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@example
s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
@r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
2009-01-03 03:03:04 -05:00
@r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
@r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}.}
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
@r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
@r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
@r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
@r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
@r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
@r{to it.}
@end example
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
2009-01-02 10:28:35 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-o
@kindex mouse-1
@kindex mouse-2
@item C-c C-c @r{or} mouse-1/2
Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@end table
@node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@section The Orgstruct minor mode
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Orgstruct mode
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex minor mode for structure editing
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode Orgstruct mode
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
orgstruct-mode}. To turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode,
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
use
@lisp
(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
@end lisp
When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org like a headline of the first line of a list item, most
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
structure editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally
have different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
cursor is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
silently in the shadow.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Tables
@cindex tables
@cindex editing tables
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
package
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@ifinfo
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
(@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@end ifinfo
@ifnotinfo
(see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
calculator).
@end ifnotinfo
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
* Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
* Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@node Built-in table editor, Narrow columns, Tables, Tables
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section The built-in table editor
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@cindex table editor, built-in
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
this:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
| Name | Phone | Age |
|-------+-------+-----|
| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
@end example
A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
@key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
@samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
create the above table, you would only type
@example
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
|Name|Phone|Age|
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
|-
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
fields.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
unpredictable for you, configure the variables
@code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
@table @kbd
@tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
@kindex C-c |
@item C-c |
Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@*
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
@kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item @key{TAB}
Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
necessary.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{TAB}
@item S-@key{TAB}
Re-align, move to previous field.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex @key{RET}
@item @key{RET}
Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
@tsubheading{Column and row editing}
@kindex M-@key{left}
@kindex M-@key{right}
@item M-@key{left}
@itemx M-@key{right}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Move the current column left/right.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
@item M-S-@key{left}
Kill the current column.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
@item M-S-@key{right}
Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{up}
@kindex M-@key{down}
@item M-@key{up}
@itemx M-@key{down}
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Move the current row up/down.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
@item M-S-@key{up}
Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
@item M-S-@key{down}
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
created below the current one.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c -
@item C-c -
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
is created above the current line.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c ^
@item C-c ^
2008-01-31 05:33:09 -05:00
Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
(alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Regions}
@kindex C-c C-x M-w
@item C-c C-x M-w
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point
and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. The process ignores
horizontal separator lines.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-w
@item C-c C-x C-w
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-y
@item C-c C-x C-y
Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2008-09-27 04:48:40 -04:00
The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
lines.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-q
2008-02-22 06:01:03 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{RET}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item C-c C-q
2008-02-22 06:01:03 -05:00
@itemx M-@kbd{RET}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Calculations}
@cindex formula, in tables
@cindex calculations, in tables
@cindex region, active
@cindex active region
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Transient mark mode
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c +
@item C-c +
Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{RET}
@item S-@key{RET}
2008-09-08 14:18:18 -04:00
When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily dispables the
increment. This key is also used by CUA mode (@pxref{Cooperation}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@kindex C-c `
@item C-c `
Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
that are not fully visible (@pxref{Narrow columns}). When called with a
@kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
edited in place.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item M-x org-table-import
Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB- or whitespace
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
separated. Useful, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
from a database, because these programs generally can write
TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
separator.
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@item C-c |
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
@kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item M-x org-table-export
2008-04-14 01:47:32 -04:00
Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Useful for data
exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
used to export the file can be configured in the variable
@code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
@code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions} for a
detailed description.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
it off with
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
@node Narrow columns, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@section Narrow columns
@cindex narrow columns in tables
The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor.
Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next
re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this
value.
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@group
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
| | | | | <6> |
| 1 | one | | 1 | one |
| 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
| 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
| 4 | four | | 4 | four |
|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@end group
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@noindent
Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field - a tool-tip window
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
@kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
C-c}.
When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
@code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
on a per-file basis with:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@example
#+STARTUP: align
#+STARTUP: noalign
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Narrow columns, Tables
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
@section Column groups
@cindex grouping columns in tables
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
@samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
@example
| | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
| / | <> | < | | > | < | > |
| # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
| # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
| # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
|---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
#+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)))
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
@end example
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2008-01-31 05:34:46 -05:00
every vertical line you'd like to have:
@example
| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
| / | < | | | < | |
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@section The Orgtbl minor mode
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Orgtbl mode
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@cindex minor mode for tables
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
example in mail mode, use
@lisp
(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@node The spreadsheet, Org Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@section The spreadsheet
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex calculations, in tables
@cindex spreadsheet capabilities
@cindex @file{calc} package
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the
formula to each relevant field.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
* References:: How to refer to another field or range
* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
@subsection References
@cindex references
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@subsubheading Field references
@cindex field references
@cindex references, to fields
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
@c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
@c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@noindent
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@@row$column
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{N},
2008-12-18 17:05:21 -05:00
or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
@samp{1}...@samp{N}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
@samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
the second etc. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
third hline in the table. Relative row numbers like @samp{-3} will not
cross hlines if the current line is too close to the hline. Instead,
the value directly at the hline is used.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
row/column is implied.
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
references because the same reference operator can reference different
fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
2008-12-19 12:28:58 -05:00
As a special case references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used to
refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
table.
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
Here are a few examples:
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@example
@@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
C2 @r{same as previous}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
$5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
E& @r{same as previous}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@@2 @r{current column, row 2}
@@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
@@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
@end example
@subsubheading Range references
@cindex range references
@cindex references, to ranges
You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
@samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
@example
$1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
$P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
@@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
@end example
@noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
@samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@subsubheading Named references
@cindex named references
@cindex references, named
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex name, of column or field
@cindex constants, in calculations
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
line like
@example
#+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
@end example
@noindent
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
constants in table formulas: For a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
@samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
@file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{Constant.el} can
supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
@code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
numbers.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
@subsection Formula syntax for Calc
@cindex formula syntax, Calc
@cindex syntax, of formulas
A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
@file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
@samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Emacs Calc Manual}),
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
@cindex vectors, in table calculations
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex format specifier
@cindex mode, for @file{calc}
A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 5)} to keep tables
compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
@code{org-calc-default-modes}.
@example
p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits}
n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format}
D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
T @r{force text interpretation}
E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
@end example
@noindent
In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to
reformat the final result. A few examples:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
$1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
$1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
$0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
$c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
@example
if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
@end example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
for string manipulation and control structures, if the Calc's
functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single quote
followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a lisp form.
The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
@file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double quotes)
containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
@samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
form, enclose the reference operator itself in double quotes, like
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
@samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in lisp.
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
'(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
@r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to the Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
'(+ $1 $2);N
@r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
'(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
@subsection Field formulas
@cindex field formula
@cindex formula, for individual table field
To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
same field. Of cause this is not true if you edit the table structure
with normal editing commands - then you must fix the equations yourself.
2008-12-19 12:28:58 -05:00
The left hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
following command
@table @kbd
@kindex C-u C-c =
@item C-u C-c =
Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
formula, with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
it to the current field and stores it.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@subsection Column formulas
@cindex column formula
@cindex formula, for table column
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
in that column, Org allows to assign a single formula to an entire
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
and will not be modified by column formulas.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
field, the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column,
evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field
contains only @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
used. For each column, Org will only remember the most recently
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
used formula. In the @samp{TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like
@samp{$4=$1+$2}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
following command:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c =
@item C-c =
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@cindex formula editing
@cindex editing, of table formulas
You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
@code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
@code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c =
@kindex C-u C-c =
@item C-c =
@itemx C-u C-c =
Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas} and @ref{Field formulas}.
@kindex C-u C-u C-c =
@item C-u C-u C-c =
Re-insert the active formula (either a
field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
@kindex C-c ?
@item C-c ?
While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@kindex C-c @}
@item C-c @}
Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned, you can
force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
@kindex C-c @{
@item C-c @{
Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-c '
@item C-c '
Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@kindex C-x C-s
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@item C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@itemx C-x C-s
Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-q
@item C-c C-q
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
@kindex C-c C-r
@item C-c C-r
Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
@code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item @key{TAB}
Pretty-print or indent lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
a lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
@item M-@key{TAB}
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{up}
@kindex S-@key{down}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
@code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
This also works for relative references, and for hline references.
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
@item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
down.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{up}
@kindex M-@key{down}
@item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
Scroll the window displaying the table.
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
@kindex C-c @}
@item C-c @}
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@end table
Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{TBLFM}
line) - during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
@kindex C-c C-c
You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line, or with the normal
recalculation commands in the table.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@subsubheading Debugging formulas
@cindex formula debugging
@cindex debugging, of table formulas
When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Updating the table
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex recomputing table fields
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@cindex updating, table
Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features} for a way to make
recalculation at least semi-automatically.
In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
following commands:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c *
@item C-c *
Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c *
@item C-u C-c *
@kindex C-u C-c C-c
@itemx C-u C-c C-c
Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@item C-u C-u C-c *
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
@itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
@end table
@node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@subsection Advanced features
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-#
@item C-#
Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{},
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
change all marks in the region.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@end table
Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
makes use of these features:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
@group
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
| # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
| ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
| # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
| | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
| ^ | | | | | at | |
| $ | max=50 | | | | | |
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
#+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end group
@end example
@noindent @b{Important}: Please note that for these special tables,
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
empty first field.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex marking characters, tables
The marking characters have the following meaning:
@table @samp
@item !
The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
@item ^
This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item _
Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
@emph{below}.
@item $
Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
a per-table basis.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item #
Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
lines will be left alone by this command.
@item *
Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
recalculation slows down editing too much.
@item
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
or @samp{*}.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@item /
Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
@samp{<N>} markers.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
Finally, just to whet your appetite on what can be done with the
fantastic @file{calc} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2008-02-10 05:52:32 -05:00
series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
functions.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
@group
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
| | Func | n | x | Result |
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
| # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
| # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
| # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
| * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
#+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
@end group
@end example
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@page
@node Org Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
@section Org Plot
@cindex graph, in tables
@cindex plot tables using gnuplot
Org Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2008-10-24 16:38:53 -04:00
using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
@uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
this in action ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot-mode installed
on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@example
@group
#+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
| Sede | Max cites | H-index |
|-----------+-----------+---------|
| Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
| Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
| Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
| Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
@end group
@end example
Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the tables headers as labels.
Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
be exercised through the @code{#+Plot:} lines preceding a table. See below
for a complete list of Org plot options. For more information and examples
2008-10-24 16:38:53 -04:00
see the org-plot tutorial at
@uref{http://legito.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@subsubheading Plot Options
@table @code
@item set
Specify any @file{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
@item title
Specify the title of the plot.
@item ind
Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
@item deps
2008-10-22 12:08:59 -04:00
Specify the columns to graph as a lisp style list, surrounded by parenthesis
and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the ind
column).
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@item type
Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
@item with
Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
(e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
Defaults to 'lines'.
@item file
If you want to plot to a file specify the @code{"path/to/desired/output-file"}.
@item labels
List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to column headers if they
exist).
@item line
Specify an entire line to be inserted in the gnuplot script.
@item map
When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
org-plot and timestamps
On 28 Oct 2008, Eric Schulte wrote:
> Hi Charles, The patch looks great, I vote we drop it 'as is' into
> org-plot.el. The only enhancement that comes to mind would be to
> expose the `time-ind' variable as a plot option. Allowing users to
> specify different time formats, but really if they're that
> sophisticated in their use of gnuplot, then they can do that on their
> own through the `set:' option. Thanks for the addition! -- Eric
If I understand you correctly, then what we want to expose is the
"timefmt" that is put into the data file and then passed to gnuplot.
The following patch is a complete one against current which adds this
(it works for me, at least), and documents the new +PLOT option
behavior.
The one thing I'm not sure about is my method of passing the timefmt
parameter all the way into the temp file creation function. I made a
buffer-local variable there to do it. That seemed the least intrusive
way to accomplish this, but it seemed like poor practice. Thoughts?
You know, I really ought to allow a person to customize this variable (I
mean, using customize).
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Changes in origin/master
Modified doc/org.texi
2008-10-30 11:35:43 -04:00
@item timefmt
Specify format of org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by gnuplot.
Defaults to '%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'.
2008-09-24 04:57:03 -04:00
@item script
If you want total control you can specify a script file (place the file name
between double quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
the path to the generated data file. Note even if you set this option you
may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
the data file.
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Hyperlinks
@cindex hyperlinks
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
* External links:: URL-like links to the world
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
@section Link format
@cindex link format
@cindex format, of links
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@example
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
[[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
cursor on the link.
If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
@code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
@section Internal links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex internal links
@cindex links, internal
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex targets, for links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in
the current file. Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My
Target][Find my target]]} lead to a text search in the current file.
The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the
link, or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). The preferred
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
match for such a link is a dedicated target: the same string in double
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
angular brackets. Targets may be located anywhere; sometimes it is
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
convenient to put them into a comment line. For example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
# <<My Target>>
@end example
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2008-11-21 13:45:51 -05:00
named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
first headline.}.
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
link. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
Links starting with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
headlines. When searching, Org mode will first try an exact match, but
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
then move on to more and more lenient searches. For example, the link
@samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
** My targets
** TODO my targets are bright
** my 20 targets are
@end example
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used.
Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and
press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more commands
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
creating links.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
earlier.
@menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
@node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@subsection Radio targets
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex radio targets
@cindex targets, radio
@cindex links, radio targets
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
cursor on or at a target.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
@section External links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex links, external
@cindex external links
@cindex links, external
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@cindex Gnus links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex BBDB links
2008-02-19 04:07:34 -05:00
@cindex IRC links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex URL links
@cindex file links
@cindex VM links
@cindex RMAIL links
@cindex WANDERLUST links
@cindex MH-E links
@cindex USENET links
@cindex SHELL links
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@cindex Info links
@cindex elisp links
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2008-02-19 04:07:34 -05:00
BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2008-06-24 02:37:50 -04:00
/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2008-06-24 02:37:50 -04:00
./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2008-11-14 03:09:00 -05:00
bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2008-02-19 04:07:34 -05:00
irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2008-11-14 08:13:48 -05:00
elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive elisp command}
elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
format}), for example:
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
[[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@noindent
If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
image,
that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
@cindex angular brackets, around links
@cindex plain text external links
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
about the end of the link, enclose them in angular brackets.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@section Handling links
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex links, handling
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c l
@cindex storing links
@item C-c l
Better implementation of unique entry IDs.
Unique identifiers for entries can now be used more efficiently.
Internally, a hash array has replaced the alist used so far to
keep track of the files in which an ID is defined. This makes it
quite fast to find an entry by ID.
There is now a new link type which looks like this:
id:GLOBALLY-UNIQUE-IDENTIFIER
This link points to a specific entry. When you move the entry to
a different file, for example if you move it to an archive
file, this link will continue to work.
The file /org-id.el/ contains an API that can be used to write
code using these identifiers, including creating IDs and finding
them wherever they are.
Org has its own method to create unique identifiers, but if the
system has /uuidgen/ command installed (Mac's and Linux systems
generally do), it will be used by default. You an also select
the method by hand, using the variable =org-id-method=.
If the ID system ever gets confused about where a certain ID is,
it initiates a global scan of all agenda files with associated
archives, all files previously known containing any IDs, and all
currently visited Org-mode files to rebuild the hash. You can
also initiate this by hand: =M-x org-id-update-id-locations=.
Running this command will also dump into the =*Messages*= buffer
information about any duplicate IDs. These should not exist, but
if you /copy/ an entry with its properties, duplicate IDs will
inevitably be produced. This is unavoidable in a plain text
system that allows you to edit the text in arbitrary ways, and a
portion of care on your side is needed to keep this system clean.
The hash is stored in the file =~/.emacs.d/.org-id-locations=.
This is also a change from previous versions where the file was
=~/.org=id-locations=. Therefore, you can remove this old file
if you have it. I am not sure what will happen if the =.emacs.d=
directory does not exists in your setup, but in modern Emacsen, I
believe it should exist. If you do not want to use IDs across
files, you can avoid the overhead with tracking IDs by
customizing the variable =org-id-track-globally=. IDs can then
still be used for links inside a single file.
IDs will also be used when you create a new link to an Org-mode
buffer. If you use =org-store-link= (normally at =C-c l=) inside
en entry in an Org-mode buffer, and ID property will be created
if it does not exist, and the stored link will be an =id:= link.
If you prefer the much less secure linking to headline text, you
can configure the variable =org-link-to-org-use-id=. The default
setting for this variable is =create-if-interactive=, meaning
that an ID will be created when you store a link interactively,
but not if you happen to be in an Org-mode file while you create
a remember note (which usually has a link to the place where you
were when starting remember).
2008-12-05 17:35:26 -05:00
Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command which
can be used in any buffer to create a link. The link will be stored for
2009-01-08 16:35:57 -05:00
later insertion into an Org buffer (see below).
For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, either by text
(unsafe), or, if @file{org-id.el} is loaded and @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}
is set, by ID property.
For VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus and BBDB buffers, the link will
indicate the current article/entry. For W3 and W3M buffers, the link goes to
the current URL. For IRC links, if you set the variable
@code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to non-nil then @kbd{C-c l} will store a
Better implementation of unique entry IDs.
Unique identifiers for entries can now be used more efficiently.
Internally, a hash array has replaced the alist used so far to
keep track of the files in which an ID is defined. This makes it
quite fast to find an entry by ID.
There is now a new link type which looks like this:
id:GLOBALLY-UNIQUE-IDENTIFIER
This link points to a specific entry. When you move the entry to
a different file, for example if you move it to an archive
file, this link will continue to work.
The file /org-id.el/ contains an API that can be used to write
code using these identifiers, including creating IDs and finding
them wherever they are.
Org has its own method to create unique identifiers, but if the
system has /uuidgen/ command installed (Mac's and Linux systems
generally do), it will be used by default. You an also select
the method by hand, using the variable =org-id-method=.
If the ID system ever gets confused about where a certain ID is,
it initiates a global scan of all agenda files with associated
archives, all files previously known containing any IDs, and all
currently visited Org-mode files to rebuild the hash. You can
also initiate this by hand: =M-x org-id-update-id-locations=.
Running this command will also dump into the =*Messages*= buffer
information about any duplicate IDs. These should not exist, but
if you /copy/ an entry with its properties, duplicate IDs will
inevitably be produced. This is unavoidable in a plain text
system that allows you to edit the text in arbitrary ways, and a
portion of care on your side is needed to keep this system clean.
The hash is stored in the file =~/.emacs.d/.org-id-locations=.
This is also a change from previous versions where the file was
=~/.org=id-locations=. Therefore, you can remove this old file
if you have it. I am not sure what will happen if the =.emacs.d=
directory does not exists in your setup, but in modern Emacsen, I
believe it should exist. If you do not want to use IDs across
files, you can avoid the overhead with tracking IDs by
customizing the variable =org-id-track-globally=. IDs can then
still be used for links inside a single file.
IDs will also be used when you create a new link to an Org-mode
buffer. If you use =org-store-link= (normally at =C-c l=) inside
en entry in an Org-mode buffer, and ID property will be created
if it does not exist, and the stored link will be an =id:= link.
If you prefer the much less secure linking to headline text, you
can configure the variable =org-link-to-org-use-id=. The default
setting for this variable is =create-if-interactive=, meaning
that an ID will be created when you store a link interactively,
but not if you happen to be in an Org-mode file while you create
a remember note (which usually has a link to the place where you
were when starting remember).
2008-12-05 17:35:26 -05:00
@samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current
conversation. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to the user/channel/server
2009-01-08 16:35:57 -05:00
under the point will be stored.
For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
(@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
and to do the search for particular file types - see @ref{Custom searches}.
The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion - see @ref{Installation}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-l
@cindex link completion
@cindex completion, of links
@cindex inserting links
@item C-c C-l
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Insert a link. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. You
can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. All links stored during the
current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}). Completion, on the other
hand, will help you to insert valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or
@samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes defined through link abbreviations
(@pxref{Link abbreviations}). The link will be inserted into the
buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed
from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a
triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
@code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
becomes the default description.@* Note that you don't have to use this
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
command to insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
or paste them straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are
automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the
optional descriptive text.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@c If the link is a @samp{file:} link and
@c the linked file is located in the same directory as the current file or
@c a subdirectory of it, the path of the file will be inserted relative to
@c the current directory.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-l
@cindex file name completion
@cindex completion, of file names
@item C-u C-c C-l
When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
directory of the current org file, if the linked file is in the current
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
@item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
link and description parts of the link.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex following links
@kindex C-c C-o
@item C-c C-o
Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
2008-10-08 06:46:51 -04:00
@command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the corresponding search.
When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
TAGS view. If the cursor is on a time stamp, it compiles the agenda for that
date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
@code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
2008-11-05 04:46:20 -05:00
visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex mouse-2
@kindex mouse-1
@item mouse-2
@itemx mouse-1
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
would. Under Emacs 22, also @kbd{mouse-1} will follow a link.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex mouse-3
@item mouse-3
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex mark ring
@kindex C-c %
@item C-c %
Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex links, returning to
@kindex C-c &
@item C-c &
Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
previously recorded positions.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-n
@kindex C-c C-x C-p
@cindex links, finding next/previous
@item C-c C-x C-n
@itemx C-c C-x C-p
Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
@lisp
(add-hook 'org-load-hook
(lambda ()
(define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
(define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
@end lisp
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
@section Using links outside Org
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
yourself):
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
(global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
(global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@section Link abbreviations
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex link abbreviations
@cindex abbreviation, links
Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
abbreviated link looks like this
@example
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
[[linkword:tag][description]]
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@end example
@noindent
where the tag is optional. Such abbreviations are resolved according to
the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist} that
relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
@lisp
@group
(setq org-link-abbrev-alist
'(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
@end group
@end lisp
If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
can define them in the file with
@example
#+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
#+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
@end example
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@noindent
In-buffer completion @pxref{Completion} can be used after @samp{[} to
complete link abbreviations.
@node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Search options in file links
@cindex search option in file links
@cindex file links, searching
File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
link, together with an explanation:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
[[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
[[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
[[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
[[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @code
@item 255
Jump to line 255.
@item My Target
Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
@samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
the linked file.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item *My Target
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item /regexp/
Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
sparse tree with the matches.
@c If the target file is a directory,
@c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
@end table
As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
2008-01-31 05:33:09 -05:00
to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@samp{[[find me]]} would.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
@section Custom Searches
@cindex custom search strings
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex search strings, custom
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like
@samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
because the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the
citation key.
If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
to be added to the hook variables
@code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
@code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
2008-01-31 05:31:19 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
@chapter TODO Items
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex TODO items
2008-06-18 12:31:16 -04:00
Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
course, you can make a document that contains inly long lists of TODO items,
but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
item emerged is always present.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Basic TODO functionality
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
@samp{TODO}, for example:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
*** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
@end example
@noindent
The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-t
@cindex cycling, of TODO states
@item C-c C-t
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
'--------------------------------'
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-t
@item C-u C-c C-t
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
2008-02-14 05:41:10 -05:00
the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords} and @ref{Setting tags} for
more information.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{right}
@kindex S-@key{left}
@item S-@key{right}
@itemx S-@key{left}
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
extensions}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-v
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@kindex C-c / t
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex sparse tree, for TODO
@item C-c C-v
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@itemx C-c / t
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds
the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
above them. With a prefix argument, search for a specific TODO. You will be
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
@code{KWD1|KWD2|...}. With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
Nth keyword in the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
arguments, find all TODO and DONE entries.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c a t
@item C-c a t
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items from all agenda
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer will
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda
commands}). @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex S-M-@key{RET}
@item S-M-@key{RET}
Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-10-16 03:54:30 -04:00
@noindent
Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Extended use of TODO keywords
@cindex extended TODO keywords
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
files.
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
@node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
@subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
@cindex TODO workflow
@cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
buffer.}:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
state.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
Or you can use @kbd{S-left} to go backward through the sequence. If you
define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
2008-02-19 03:18:46 -05:00
(@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
(@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
@ref{Tracking TODO state changes} for more information.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@subsection TODO keywords as types
@cindex TODO types
@cindex names as TODO keywords
@cindex types as TODO keywords
The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
be set up like this:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
(setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
@kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things
Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items
from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}.
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
@cindex TODO keyword sets
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
@code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
like this:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
(sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
(sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
@end lisp
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
@kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
(nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-S-@key{right}
@kindex C-S-@key{left}
@item C-S-@key{right}
@itemx C-S-@key{left}
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
@kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or @code{DONE} to
@code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to @code{CANCELED}.
@kindex S-@key{right}
@kindex S-@key{left}
@item S-@key{right}
@itemx S-@key{left}
@kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through
@emph{all} keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}}
would switch from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@subsection Fast access to TODO states
If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
key after each keyword, in parenthesis. For example:
@lisp
(setq org-todo-keywords
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
(sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
(sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
@end lisp
If you then press @code{C-u C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the
entry will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove
any TODO keyword from an entry. Should you like this way of selecting
TODO states a lot, you might want to set the variable
@code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} to @code{t} and make this behavior
the default. Check also the variable
@code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows to change the TODO
2008-02-14 05:41:10 -05:00
state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you
like to mingle the two concepts.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
@cindex keyword options
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@cindex per-file keywords
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
file:
@example
#+SEQ_TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
@end example
or
@example
#+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
@end example
A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
@example
2008-01-31 05:36:08 -05:00
#+SEQ_TODO: TODO | DONE
#+SEQ_TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
#+SEQ_TODO: | CANCELED
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@end example
@cindex completion, of option keywords
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
@noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
@samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
@cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
@kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
for the current buffer.}.
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@node Faces for TODO keywords, , Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@subsection Faces for TODO keywords
@cindex faces, for TODO keywords
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
@code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
@code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
@lisp
2008-12-04 09:27:25 -05:00
@group
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
(setq org-todo-keyword-faces
'(("TODO" . org-warning)
("DEFERRED" . shadow)
("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
2008-12-04 09:27:25 -05:00
@end group
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
@emph{should} work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If
necessary, define a special face and use that.
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@page
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
@section Progress logging
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@cindex progress logging
@cindex logging, of progress
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode can automatically record a time stamp and possibly a note when
2008-02-14 13:47:41 -05:00
you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
work time}.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@menu
* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
@end menu
@node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
@subsection Closing items
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@lisp
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
(setq org-log-done 'time)
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end lisp
@noindent
2008-02-19 02:16:39 -05:00
Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@lisp
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
(setq org-log-done 'note)
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
@noindent
You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
giving you an overview of what has been done.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@node Tracking TODO state changes, , Closing items, Progress logging
@subsection Tracking TODO state changes
When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow
states}), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred
2008-02-19 02:16:39 -05:00
and maybe take a note about this change. Since it is normally too much
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
to record a note for every state, Org mode expects configuration on a
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by adding special markers
2008-02-19 02:16:39 -05:00
@samp{!} (for a time stamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note) in parenthesis
after each keyword. For example, with the setting
2008-02-14 13:47:41 -05:00
@lisp
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
(setq org-todo-keywords
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end lisp
@noindent
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
request that a time is recorded when the entry is turned into
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two time stamps
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
However, it will never prompt for two notes - if you have configured
both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
2008-02-20 08:54:42 -05:00
the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: The
@samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
entering the state, a time stamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
2008-03-05 03:14:59 -05:00
WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
configured.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-02-19 02:59:25 -05:00
You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
to a buffer:
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@example
2008-02-19 02:16:39 -05:00
#+SEQ_TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end example
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
@code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@example
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
* TODO Log each state with only a time
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
:END:
* TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
:END:
* TODO No logging at all
:PROPERTIES:
:LOGGING: nil
:END:
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end example
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Priorities
@cindex priorities
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up enough TODO items that
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like
this
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
*** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
@end example
@noindent
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie
is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
no inherent meaning to Org mode.
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
to be TODO items.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
@item @kbd{C-c ,}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
@key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{up}
@kindex S-@key{down}
@item S-@key{up}
@itemx S-@key{down}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the
option @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'}.}. Note that these
keys are also used to modify time stamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}).
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Furthermore, these keys are also used by CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
@code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
@code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
priority):
@example
#+PRIORITIES: A C B
@end example
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
@cindex tasks, breaking down
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
2008-05-19 08:11:47 -04:00
subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
be updates each time the todo status of a child changes. For example:
@example
* Organize Party [33%]
** TODO Call people [1/2]
*** TODO Peter
*** DONE Sarah
** TODO Buy food
** DONE Talk to neighbor
@end example
If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when all
chilrden are done, you can use the following setup:
@example
(defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
"Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
(let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
(org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
(add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
@end example
Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@section Checkboxes
@cindex checkboxes
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
Here is an example of a checkbox list.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@example
2008-02-05 13:52:59 -05:00
* TODO Organize party [2/4]
- [-] call people [1/3]
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
- [ ] Peter
- [X] Sarah
- [ ] Sam
- [X] order food
- [ ] think about what music to play
- [X] talk to the neighbors
@end example
2008-02-05 13:52:59 -05:00
Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
2008-02-20 08:54:42 -05:00
parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
2008-02-05 13:52:59 -05:00
checked.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@cindex statistics, for checkboxes
@cindex checkbox statistics
2008-02-05 13:52:59 -05:00
The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
cookies indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been
checked off, and the total number of checkboxes are present. This can
give you an idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a
folded entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the
first line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers all checkboxes
structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie appear. You
have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either @samp{[/]} or
@samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m} result, as in
the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about the
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively).
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Toggle checkbox at point. With a prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]},
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
which is considered to be an intermediate state.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-b
@item C-c C-x C-b
Toggle checkbox at point.
@itemize @minus
@item
If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. If you
want to toggle all boxes in the region independently, use a prefix
argument.
@item
If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@end itemize
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
@item M-S-@key{RET}
Insert a new item with a checkbox.
This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
(@pxref{Plain lists}).
@kindex C-c #
@item C-c #
Update the checkbox statistics in the current outline entry. When
called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox
statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes
with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. If you
delete boxes or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things
back into synch. Or simply toggle any checkbox twice with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@chapter Tags
@cindex tags
@cindex headline tagging
@cindex matching, tags
@cindex sparse tree, tag based
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
support for tags.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
2008-12-04 08:24:21 -05:00
headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
@samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
@samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
Tags will by default get a bold face with the same color as the headline.
You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
@code{org-tag-faces}, much in the same way as you can do for TODO keywords
(@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@menu
* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
@end menu
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
@section Tag inheritance
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@cindex tag inheritance
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@cindex inheritance, of tags
@cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
well. For example, in the list
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Meeting with the French group :work:
** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
*** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
2008-05-19 13:48:52 -04:00
explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
a file should inherit as if these tags would be defined in a hypothetical
level zero that surounds the entire file.
@example
#+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
@end example
@noindent
To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
2008-11-27 07:15:29 -05:00
the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
@code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
2008-05-19 13:48:52 -04:00
When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
2008-11-27 07:15:29 -05:00
on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
as well@footnote{This is only true if the the search does not involve more
complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
match in a subtree, configure the variable
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
@section Setting tags
@cindex setting tags
@cindex tags, setting
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
also a special command for inserting tags:
@table @kbd
2008-10-16 08:04:04 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-q
@item C-c C-q
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@cindex completion, of tags
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
2008-10-16 08:04:04 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@end table
Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
the default tags for a given file with lines like
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
#+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
#+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
#+TAGS:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
2008-04-01 10:42:15 -04:00
entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
@file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
like:
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
(setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
@noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on then you
can, instead, set the TAGS option line as:
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@noindent
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive. By using
braces, as in:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
#+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
these lines to activate any changes.
2008-04-01 03:39:36 -04:00
@noindent
To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-mode-alist}
you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
of the braces. The previous example would be set globally by the following
configuration:
@lisp
(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
(:endgroup . nil)
("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
@end lisp
If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
keys:
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@table @kbd
@item a-z...
Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item @key{TAB}
Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
@kindex @key{SPC}
@item @key{SPC}
Clear all tags for this line.
@kindex @key{RET}
@item @key{RET}
Accept the modified set.
@item C-g
Abort without installing changes.
@item q
If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
@item !
Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
exception) assign several tags from such a group.
@item C-c
Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
selection window.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@noindent
This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
@samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
@samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
@samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
@key{RET} @key{RET}}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
If you find that most of the time, you need only a single key press to
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
modify your list of tags, set the variable
@code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection - it will immediately exit
after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
@kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
(in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
@node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
@section Tag searches
@cindex tag searches
@cindex searching for tags
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
information into special lists.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@kindex C-c \
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@kindex C-c / T
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@item C-c \
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@itemx C-c / T
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
@kindex C-c a m
@item C-c a m
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@kindex C-c a M
@item C-c a M
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
@end table
@cindex Boolean logic, for tag searches
A @i{tags} search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and
@samp{|} for OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}.
Parenthesis are currently not implemented. A tag may also be preceded
by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for
positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+}
or @samp{-} is present. Examples:
@table @samp
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item +work-boss
Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
@samp{:boss:}.
@item work|laptop
Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
@item work|laptop&night
Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
@samp{:night:}.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@end table
@cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
You may also test for TODO keywords (@pxref{TODO extensions}) and properties
(@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same time as matching tags. For a
guide on how to match properties, see @ref{Property searches}. To match a
specific TODO keyword, include an expression like @samp{+TODO="NEXT"} as one
of the terms in a tags search.
There is also the possibility to end the tags part of the match (which may
include several terms connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then
specify a Boolean expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then
similar to the tag matches, but should be applied with consideration: For
example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords can not meaningfully
be combined with boolean AND. However, @emph{negative selection} combined
with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that
actually have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M},
or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Examples:
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@table @samp
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
@item work+TODO="WAITING"
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
keyword @samp{WAITING}.
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
@item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
@item work/WAITING
Same as the first example.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
nor @samp{NEXT}
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
@item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@samp{NEXT}.
@end table
@cindex regular expressions, with tags search
Any element of the tag/todo match can be a regular expression - in this
case it must be enclosed in curly braces. For example,
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
@samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}. You may also use a
regular expression in @samp{TODO=@{^W@}} which would match TODO keywords
starting with the letter @samp{W}.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@cindex level, require for tags/property match
@cindex category, require for tags/property match
You can also require a headline to be of a certain level or category, by
writing instead of any TAG an expression like @samp{LEVEL=3} or
@samp{CATEGORY="work"}, respectively. For example, a search
@samp{+LEVEL=3+boss/-DONE} lists all level three headlines that have the
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword DONE.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-10-31 04:11:52 -04:00
Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
other properties will slow down the search.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@chapter Properties and Columns
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@cindex properties
Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
you document bugs and plan releases of a piece of software. Instead of
using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CD's,
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
where properties could be things such as the album artist, date of
release, number of tracks, and so on.
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
(@pxref{Column view}).
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@menu
* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Property searches:: Matching property values
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
@section Property syntax
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex property syntax
@cindex drawer, for properties
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
@example
* CD collection
** Classic
*** Goldberg Variations
:PROPERTIES:
:Title: Goldberg Variations
:Composer: J.S. Bach
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
:Artist: Glen Gould
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
:Publisher: Deutsche Grammphon
:NDisks: 1
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
:END:
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
@example
* CD collection
:PROPERTIES:
:NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
2008-11-12 10:45:23 -05:00
:Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
:END:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
file, use a line like
@example
#+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
@end example
Property values set with the global variable
@code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org files.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
The following commands help to work with properties:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
@item M-@key{TAB}
After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x p
@item C-c C-x p
Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
information like deadlines.
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
@item C-c C-c s
Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
can be inserted using completion.
@kindex S-@key{right}
@kindex S-@key{left}
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
@item C-c C-c d
Remove a property from the current entry.
@item C-c C-c D
Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@item C-c C-c c
Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
nearest column format definition.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
@section Special properties
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex properties, special
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Special properties provide alternative access method to Org mode
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
features discussed in the previous chapters, like the TODO state or the
priority of an entry. This interface exists so that you can include
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
these states into columns view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
queries. The following property names are special and should not be
used as keys in the properties drawer:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@example
TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling time stamp, without the angular brackets.}
2008-01-31 05:37:56 -05:00
TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less time stamp in the entry.}
TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive time stamp in the entry.}
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
@r{must be run first to compute the values.}
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@section Property searches
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex properties, searching
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@cindex searching, of properties
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}), and
the same logic applies. For example, here is a search string:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@example
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
+work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
+With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end example
@noindent
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
@itemize @minus
@item
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
@samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
@item
If the comparison value is enclosed in double
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
quotes, a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
@item
If the comparison value is enclosed in double quotes @emph{and} angular
brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
New ways to specify time comparison values in property searches.
In addition to "<now>", "<today>", "<yesterday>", and
"<tomorrow>", there are more special values accepted now in
time comparisons in property searches: You may use strings
like =<+3d>= or =<-2w>=, with units d, w, m, and y for day,
week, month, and year, respectively
Thanks to Linday Todd for this proposal.
2008-11-29 12:49:30 -05:00
assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
@code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
@code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
respectively, can be used.
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
@item
If the comparison value is enclosed
in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
match.
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
@end itemize
So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
@samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
2008-07-02 13:43:35 -04:00
on or after October 11, 2008.
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
inheritance} for details.
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
single property:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c / p
@item C-c / p
Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
is created with all entries that define this property with the given
value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
a regular expression and matched against the property values.
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@section Property Inheritance
2008-03-21 05:34:43 -04:00
@cindex properties, inheritance
@cindex inheritance, of properties
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself for an
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
inheritance model of properties: If the parent in a tree has a certain
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
@code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t}, to make
2008-03-21 05:34:43 -04:00
all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
inherited properties.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
least for the special applications for which they are used:
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@table @code
@item COLUMNS
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
(@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
subtree from where columns view is turned on.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item CATEGORY
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
applies to the entire subtree.
@item ARCHIVE
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
2008-02-20 08:54:42 -05:00
@item LOGGING
The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
@section Column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@emph{column view}. In column view, each outline item is turned into a
table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@menu
* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end menu
@node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Defining columns
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex column view, for properties
@cindex properties, column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
done by defining a column format line.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@menu
* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
@subsubsection Scope of column definitions
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
@end example
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
@code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@example
** Top node for columns view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
:PROPERTIES:
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
:END:
@end example
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
deeper part of the tree.
@node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
@subsubsection Column attributes
A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
definition looks like this:
@example
%[width]property[(title)][@{summary-type@}]
@end example
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@noindent
Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
width @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
@r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
property @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
(title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
@r{property name is used.}
@{summary-type@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
@r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
@r{Supported summary types are:}
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
@{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
@{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
@{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.}
@{X@} @r{Checkbox status, [X] if all children are [X].}
2008-02-12 14:21:23 -05:00
@{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, [n/m].}
@{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, [n%].}
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@noindent
Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
values.
@example
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
:COLUMNS: %20ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line - it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
%10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
:Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
:Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
:Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
@end example
The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
2008-03-01 04:58:17 -05:00
column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
@samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
in the subtree.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
@subsection Using column view
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
@item C-c C-x C-c
Create the column view for the local environment. This command searches
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that defines
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
the entire tree, starting from the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
property. If none is found, the format is taken from the @code{#+COLUMNS}
line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column
view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
@kindex r
@item r
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
@kindex g
@item g
Same as @kbd{r}.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@kindex q
@item q
Exit column view.
@tsubheading{Editing values}
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
Move through the column view from field to field.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
have to have specified allowed values for a property.
2008-06-09 03:53:19 -04:00
@item 1..9,0
Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@kindex n
@kindex p
@itemx n / p
Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex e
@item e
Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
or fast selection interface will pop up.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex v
@item v
View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
the column is smaller than that of the value.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@kindex a
@item a
Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
current column view.
@tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
@kindex <
@kindex >
@item < / >
Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
@kindex S-M-@key{right}
@item S-M-@key{right}
2008-09-18 04:24:57 -04:00
Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@kindex S-M-@key{left}
@item S-M-@key{left}
Delete the current column.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
@subsection Capturing column view
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
this @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
2008-03-01 04:58:17 -05:00
of this block looks like this:
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN: columnview
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@example
* The column view
#+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
#+END:
@end example
@noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
@table @code
@item :id
This is most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
in a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
capture, you can use 3 values:
@example
local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
2008-12-22 02:13:20 -05:00
"file:path-to-file"
@r{run column view at the top of this file}
"ID" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
2008-05-19 02:22:51 -04:00
@r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
@r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
@r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@end example
@item :hlines
When @code{t}, insert a hline after every line. When a number N, insert
a hline before each headline with level @code{<= N}.
@item :vlines
When set to @code{t}, enforce column groups to get vertical lines.
2008-03-01 04:58:17 -05:00
@item :maxlevel
When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
@item :skip-empty-rows
When set to @code{t}, skip row where the only non-empty specifier of the
column view is @code{ITEM}.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@end table
@noindent
The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
@table @kbd
2008-09-11 11:02:03 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-x i
@item C-c C-x i
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
for the scope or id of the view.
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
@itemx C-c C-x C-u
Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@end table
2008-09-08 03:43:41 -04:00
You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
instructions in front of the table - these will survive an update of the
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
2008-09-08 03:43:41 -04:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@section The Property API
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex properties, API
@cindex API, for properties
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
property API}.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@node Dates and Times, Capture, Properties and Columns, Top
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@chapter Dates and Times
@cindex dates
@cindex times
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@cindex time stamps
@cindex date stamps
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
is used in a much wider sense.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
@section Timestamps, deadlines and scheduling
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@cindex time stamps
@cindex ranges, time
@cindex date stamps
@cindex deadlines
@cindex scheduling
A time stamp is a specification of a date (possibly with time or a range
of times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
@samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is the standard ISO date/time format. To
use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A time stamp
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry. Its
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@table @var
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item Plain time stamp; Event; Appointment
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@cindex timestamp
A simple time stamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
plain time stamp will be shown exactly on that date.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@example
* Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
* Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
@end example
@item Time stamp with repeater interval
@cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
A time stamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months(m), or years(y). The
following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
@example
* Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
@end example
@item Diary-style sexp entries
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
package. For example
@example
* The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
<%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
@end example
@item Time/Date range
@cindex timerange
@cindex date range
Two time stamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
@example
** Meeting in Amsterdam
<2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
@end example
@item Inactive time stamp
@cindex timestamp, inactive
@cindex inactive timestamp
Just like a plain time stamp, but with square brackets instead of
angular ones. These time stamps are inactive in the sense that they do
@emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
@example
* Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
@end example
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@section Creating timestamps
@cindex creating timestamps
@cindex timestamps, creating
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
For Org mode to recognize time stamps, they need to be in the specific
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
format. All commands listed below produce time stamps in the correct
format.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c .
@item C-c .
2008-09-05 01:58:33 -04:00
Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding time stamp. When the cursor is
at an existing time stamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
succession, a time range is inserted.
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
@c
@kindex C-u C-c .
@item C-u C-c .
Like @kbd{C-c .}, but use the alternative format which contains date
and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes,
see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
@c
@kindex C-c !
@item C-c !
Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive time stamp that will not cause
an agenda entry.
@c
@kindex C-c <
@item C-c <
Insert a time stamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c >
@item C-c >
Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
instead.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-o
@item C-c C-o
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
Access the agenda for the date given by the time stamp or -range at
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{left}
@itemx S-@key{right}
Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{up}
@kindex S-@key{down}
@item S-@key{up}
@itemx S-@key{down}
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
year, month, day, hour or minute. Note that if the cursor is in a
headline and not at a time stamp, these same keys modify the priority of
an item. (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-y
@cindex evaluate time range
@item C-c C-y
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
the following column).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@menu
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@subsection The date/time prompt
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex date, reading in minibuffer
@cindex time, reading in minibuffer
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown as an ISO
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
date, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for an ISO date. But it
will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or time
information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
is in there and derive anything you have not specified from the
@emph{default date and time}. The default is usually the current date
and time, but when modifying an existing time stamp, or when entering
the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When filling in information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
will want to enter a date in the future: If you omit the month/year and
the given day/month is @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a
future date@footnote{See the variable
@code{org-read-date-prefer-future}.}.
For example, lets assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
in @b{bold}.
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@example
3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
Fri --> nearest Friday (defaultdate or later)
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
sep 15 --> @b{2006}-11-15
feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@end example
Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
@emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
letter [dwmy] to indicate change in days weeks, months, years. With a
single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
2008-01-31 05:37:24 -05:00
double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
the nth such day. E.g.
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@example
2008-05-02 12:00:20 -04:00
+0 --> today
. --> today
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
+4d --> four days from today
+4 --> same as above
+2w --> two weeks from today
++5 --> five days from default date
2008-01-31 05:37:24 -05:00
+2tue --> second tuesday from now.
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@end example
The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex calendar, for selecting date
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
@code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
@key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
from the minibuffer:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex <
@kindex >
@kindex mouse-1
@kindex S-@key{right}
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{down}
@kindex S-@key{up}
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
@kindex @key{RET}
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@example
> / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
@key{RET} @r{Choose date in calendar.}
@end example
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
@code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
@subsection Custom time format
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@cindex custom date/time format
@cindex time format, custom
@cindex date format, custom
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
@code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x C-t
@item C-c C-x C-t
Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@noindent
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
format does not @emph{replace} the default format - instead it is put
@emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
following consequences:
@itemize @bullet
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
You cannot place the cursor onto a time stamp anymore, only before or
after.
@item
The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
each component of a time stamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
time will be changed by one minute.
@item
2008-01-31 05:34:50 -05:00
If the time stamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
When you delete a time stamp character-by-character, it will only
disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
@item
If the custom time stamp format is longer than the default and you are
using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
format is shorter, things do work as expected.
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
@section Deadlines and scheduling
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
A time stamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@table @var
@item DEADLINE
@cindex DEADLINE keyword
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
to be finished on that date.
On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
approaching or missed deadline, starting
@code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
*** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
@end example
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@item SCHEDULED
@cindex SCHEDULED keyword
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
date.
The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
I.e., the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@example
*** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@noindent
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
mark this entry with a simple plain time stamp, to get this item shown
on the date where it applies. This is a frequent mis-understanding from
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org-users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
want to start working on an action item.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
You may use time stamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
assumption that the time stamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
@c
@code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
@c
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
2008-01-31 05:38:46 -05:00
know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
sexp entry matches.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@menu
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
The following commands allow to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
an item:
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@table @kbd
@c
@kindex C-c C-d
@item C-c C-d
Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
happen in the line directly following the headline. When called with a
prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed from the entry.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
@c
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@kindex C-c / d
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item C-c / d
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
all deadlines due tomorrow.
@c
@kindex C-c C-s
@item C-c C-s
Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove
the scheduling date from the entry.
2008-06-16 10:26:30 -04:00
@c
@kindex C-c C-x C-k
@kindex k a
@kindex k s
@item C-c C-x C-k
Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
schedule the marked item.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@end table
@node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Repeated tasks
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
or plain time stamp. In the following example
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@example
** TODO Pay the rent
DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
@end example
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the
task has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month
2008-02-28 02:26:22 -05:00
starting from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special
warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater comes first and the
warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry
DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating
time stamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state
back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would
actually switch the date like this:
@example
** TODO Pay the rent
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
@end example
2008-04-15 03:03:24 -04:00
A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
@code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
@code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
will aslo be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
will be visible.
2008-03-07 04:38:48 -05:00
With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
month. So if you have not payed the rent for three months, marking this
entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
2008-04-15 03:03:24 -04:00
him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
2008-03-07 04:38:48 -05:00
like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
2008-03-07 04:38:48 -05:00
@example
** TODO Call Father
DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
and marked it done on Saturday.
** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
today.
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
task - just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
@node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@section Clocking work time
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode allows you to clock the time you spent on specific tasks in a
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x C-i
@item C-c C-x C-i
Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
@code{:CLOCK:} drawer (see also the variable
2008-04-25 02:18:49 -04:00
@code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
with letter @kbd{d}.
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-o
@item C-c C-x C-o
Stop the clock (clock-out). The inserts another timestamp at the same
location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
time stamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
@code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-y
@item C-c C-y
Recompute the time interval after changing one of the time stamps. This
is only necessary if you edit the time stamps directly. If you change
them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-t
@item C-c C-t
Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
if it is running in this same item.
@kindex C-c C-x C-x
@item C-c C-x C-x
Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-j
@item C-c C-x C-j
2008-04-25 02:18:49 -04:00
Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
@kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
tasks.
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-d
@item C-c C-x C-d
Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
when you change the buffer (see variable
@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x C-r
@item C-c C-x C-r
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
2008-01-31 05:36:37 -05:00
at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
update it.
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN: clocktable
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
#+END: clocktable
@end example
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
:maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
:emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
:scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
file @r{the full current buffer}
subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
treeN @r{the surrounding level N tree, for example @code{tree3}}
tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
agenda @r{all agenda files}
("file"..) @r{scan these files}
2008-04-18 03:50:50 -04:00
file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
:block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
@r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
@r{these formats:}
2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
2007-12 @r{December 2007}
2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
2007 @r{the year 2007}
today, yesterday, today-N @r{a relative day}
thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N @r{a relative week}
thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N @r{a relative month}
thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N @r{a relative year}
@r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
:tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times}
:tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times}
2008-04-24 10:44:33 -04:00
:step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
@r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
2008-03-07 06:48:16 -05:00
:link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins}
2008-11-10 14:57:48 -05:00
:formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
@r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds column with % time.}
@r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
@r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
So to get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
day, you could write
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@example
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
#+END: clocktable
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
parameters must be specified in a single line - the line is broken here
only to fit it onto the manual.}
@example
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
:tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
#+END: clocktable
@end example
2008-11-10 14:57:48 -05:00
A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
@example
#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
#+END: clocktable
@end example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
@itemx C-c C-x C-u
Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
2008-04-01 11:37:03 -04:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{left}
@itemx S-@key{right}
Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
@code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@end table
The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
worked on or closed during a day.
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
@node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
@section Effort estimates
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
@cindex effort estimates
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. Clearly the best way to
work with effort estimates is through column view (@pxref{Column view}). You
should start by setting up discrete values for effort estimates, and a
@code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values together with clock sums (if
you want to clock your time). For a specific buffer you can use
@example
#+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
2008-04-19 01:21:33 -04:00
#+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
@end example
@noindent
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
setup may be advised.
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
2008-05-18 06:29:09 -04:00
column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
2008-04-18 12:03:08 -04:00
an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
@node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
@section Taking notes with a relative timer
@cindex relative timer
When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x .
@item C-c C-x .
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
restarted.
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x -
@item C-c C-x -
Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
argument, first reset the timer to 0.
2008-11-25 14:20:52 -05:00
@kindex M-@key{RET}
@item M-@key{RET}
2009-01-06 00:30:38 -05:00
Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
2008-11-25 14:20:52 -05:00
new timer items.
2009-01-06 00:30:38 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x ,
@item C-c C-x ,
Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused. With prefix
argument, stop it entirely.
@kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
@item C-u C-c C-x ,
Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
Implement timer for timed notes.
This patch implements a relative time for taking timed notes, useful
for example while watching a video, or during a meeting which is also
recorded. Here are the new commands:
- `C-c C-x .' ::
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time
you use this, the timer will be started. When called
with a prefix argument, the timer is reset to 0.
- `C-c C-x -' ::
Insert a description list item with the current relative
time. With a prefix argument, first reset the timer to 0.
- `C-c C-x 0' ::
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer.
By default, the timer is reset to 0. When called with a
`C-u' prefix, reset the timer to specific starting
offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this
can be used to restart taking notes after a break in the
process. When called with a double prefix argument
`C-c C-u', change all timer strings in the active
region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer
strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right
moment.
2008-11-25 06:07:23 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x 0
@item C-c C-x 0
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
prefix argument @kbd{C-c C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
not started at exactly the right moment.
@end table
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@node Capture, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
@chapter Capture
@cindex capture
An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
Org uses the @file{remember} package to create tasks, and stores files
related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory.
@menu
* Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
* Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
@end menu
@node Remember, Attachments, Capture, Capture
@section Remember
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@cindex @file{remember.el}
The @i{Remember} package by John Wiegley lets you store quick notes with
little interruption of your work flow. See
@uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for more
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
information. It is an excellent way to add new notes and tasks to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org files. Org significantly expands the possibilities of
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@i{remember}: You may define templates for different note types, and
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
associate target files and headlines with specific templates. It also
allows you to select the location where a note should be stored
interactively, on the fly.
@menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
* Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
* Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
* Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Setting up Remember, Remember templates, Remember, Remember
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@subsection Setting up Remember
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
The following customization will tell @i{remember} to use org files as
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
target, and to create annotations compatible with Org links.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
(org-remember-insinuate)
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
(setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/")
(setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
(define-key global-map "\C-cr" 'org-remember)
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
The last line binds the command @code{org-remember} to a global
key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c r} is only a
suggestion.}. @code{org-remember} basically just calls @code{remember},
but it makes a few things easier: If there is an active region, it will
automatically copy the region into the remember buffer. It also allows
to jump to the buffer and location where remember notes are being
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
stored: Just call @code{org-remember} with a prefix argument. If you
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
use two prefix arguments, Org jumps to the location where the last
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
remember note was stored.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-11-18 14:32:01 -05:00
The remember buffer will actually use @code{org-mode} as its major mode, so
that all editing features of Org-mode are available. In addition to this, a
minor mode @code{org-remember-mode} is turned on, for the single purpose that
you can use its keymap @code{org-remember-mode-map} to overwrite some of
Org-mode's key bindings.
2008-06-16 10:26:30 -04:00
You can also call @code{org-remember} in a special way from the agenda,
using the @kbd{k r} key combination. With this access, any time stamps
inserted by the selected remember template (see below) will default to
the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up Remember, Remember
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@subsection Remember templates
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@cindex templates, for remember
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
In combination with Org, you can use templates to generate
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
different types of @i{remember} notes. For example, if you would like
to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for
journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could
use:
@example
(setq org-remember-templates
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
'(("Todo" ?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org" "Tasks")
("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org")
("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@noindent In these entries, the first string is just a name, and the
character specifies how to select the template. It is useful if the
2008-06-13 04:20:45 -04:00
character is also the first letter of the name. The next string specifies
the template. Two more (optional) strings give the file in which, and the
headline under which the new note should be stored. The file (if not present
or @code{nil}) defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading to
@code{org-remember-default-headline}. If the file name is not an absolute
path, it will be interpreted relative to @code{org-directory}. The heading
can also be the symbols @code{top} or @code{bottom} to send note as level 1
entries to the beginning or end of the file, respectively.
An optional sixth element specifies the contexts in which the user can select
the template. This element can be a list of major modes or a function.
@code{org-remember} will first check whether the function returns @code{t} or
if we are in any of the listed major mode, and exclude templates fo which
this condition is not fulfilled. Templates that do not specify this element
at all, or that use @code{nil} or @code{t} as a value will always be
selectable.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
So for example:
@example
(setq org-remember-templates
2008-03-10 12:59:08 -04:00
'(("Bug" ?b "* BUG %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/BUGS.org" "Bugs" (emacs-lisp-mode))
2008-06-13 04:20:45 -04:00
("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "X" my-check)
2008-03-10 06:13:39 -04:00
("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@end example
The first template will only be available when invoking @code{org-remember}
from an buffer in @code{emacs-lisp-mode}. The second template will only be
available when the function @code{my-check} returns @code{t}. The third
template will be proposed in any context.
2008-05-02 03:01:56 -04:00
When you call @kbd{M-x org-remember} (or @kbd{M-x remember}) to remember
something, Org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like
@example
* TODO
[[file:link to where you called remember]]
@end example
@noindent
During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes allow dynamic
insertion of content:
@example
%^@{prompt@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
@r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
@r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
2008-06-15 01:09:12 -04:00
%a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
%A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
%i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.}
@r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
%t @r{time stamp, date only}
%T @r{time stamp with date and time}
%u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive time stamps}
%^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
@r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
%n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
2008-04-10 02:27:56 -04:00
%c @r{Current kill ring head.}
%x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
%^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
%^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
%^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
2008-10-02 12:07:12 -04:00
%k @r{title of currently clocked task}
%K @r{link to currently clocked task}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
%^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
2008-09-22 06:15:33 -04:00
%^@{prop@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @code{prop}}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
%:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
%[pathname] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @code{pathname}}
%(sexp) @r{evaluate elisp @code{(sexp)} and replace with the result}
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
%! @r{immediately store note after completing the template}
@r{(skipping the @kbd{C-c C-c} that normally triggers storing)}
2008-06-11 01:15:56 -04:00
%& @r{jump to target location immediately after storing note}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@end example
@noindent
For specific link types, the following keywords will be
defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
hyperlink types}), any property you store with
@code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in remember templates in a
similar way.}:
@example
Link type | Available keywords
-------------------+----------------------------------------------
bbdb | %:name %:company
2008-02-19 04:07:34 -05:00
bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
| %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
| %:to %:toname %:toaddress
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
| %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
w3, w3m | %:url
info | %:file %:node
calendar | %:date"
@end example
@noindent
To place the cursor after template expansion use:
@example
%? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
@end example
@noindent
2008-02-09 19:48:09 -05:00
If you change your mind about which template to use, call
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new
template that will be filled with the previous context information.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Storing notes, Refiling notes, Remember templates, Remember
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@subsection Storing notes
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-05-02 03:01:56 -04:00
When you are finished preparing a note with @i{remember}, you have to press
@kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. If you have started the clock in the
remember buffer, you will first be asked if you want to clock out
now@footnote{To avoid this query, configure the variable
@code{org-remember-clock-out-on-exit}.}. If you answer @kbd{n}, the clock
2008-06-18 03:24:05 -04:00
will continue to run after the note was filed away.
2008-05-02 03:01:56 -04:00
The handler will then store the note in the file and under the headline
specified in the template, or it will use the default file and headlines.
The window configuration will be restored, sending you back to the working
context before the call to @code{remember}. To re-use the location found
during the last call to @code{remember}, exit the remember buffer with
2008-09-04 04:19:46 -04:00
@kbd{C-0 C-c C-c}, i.e. specify a zero prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2008-10-02 12:07:12 -04:00
Another special case is @kbd{C-2 C-c C-c} which files the note as a child of
the currently clocked item.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
If you want to store the note directly to a different place, use
2008-09-04 04:19:46 -04:00
@kbd{C-1 C-c C-c} instead to exit remember@footnote{Configure the
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
variable @code{org-remember-store-without-prompt} to make this behavior
the default.}. The handler will then first prompt for a target file -
if you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the template is used.
Then the command offers the headings tree of the selected file, with the
cursor position at the default headline (if you had specified one in the
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
template). You can either immediately press @key{RET} to get the note
placed there. Or you can use the following keys to find a different
location:
@example
@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
u @r{One level up.}
@c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
@end example
@noindent
Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right}
then leads to the following result.
@multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65
@item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted}
@item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor, first or last
@item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
@item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading
@item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file or level 1 at beginning
@item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
@item not on headline @tab @key{RET}
@tab at cursor position, level taken from context.
@end multitable
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the text has
a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. If not, a
headline is constructed from the current date. If you have indented the text
of the note below the headline, the indentation will be adapted if inserting
the note into the tree requires demotion from level 1.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Refiling notes, , Storing notes, Remember
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@subsection Refiling notes
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@cindex refiling notes
Remember is usually used to quickly capture notes and tasks into one or
a few capture lists. When reviewing the captured data, you may want to
refile some of the entries into a different list, for example into a
project. Cutting, finding the right location and then pasting the note
is cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following
special command:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-w
@item C-c C-w
2008-11-10 16:17:57 -05:00
Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
2008-11-24 04:59:10 -05:00
Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
2008-11-10 16:17:57 -05:00
last subitem.@*
By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
2008-11-24 04:59:10 -05:00
select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
@code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}.
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
@kindex C-u C-c C-w
@item C-u C-c C-w
Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
@item C-u C-u C-c C-w
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@end table
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@node Attachments, , Remember, Capture
@section Attachments
@cindex attachments
It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can be used to establish associations with
files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
your org-file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org-files from one
directory to the next, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
2008-10-08 06:46:51 -04:00
to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
@code{git-init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
@noindent The following commands deal with attachments.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-a
@item C-c C-a
The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
keys, a list of commands is displayed and you need to press an additional key
to select a command:
@table @kbd
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-a a
@item a
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
2008-10-09 06:19:43 -04:00
Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a c
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-a m
@kindex C-c C-a l
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
@item c/m/l
Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
2008-10-09 06:19:43 -04:00
Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a n
@item n
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
@kindex C-c C-a z
@item z
Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
attachments yourself.
@kindex C-c C-a o
@item o
2008-10-05 05:21:18 -04:00
Open current task's attachment. If there are more than one, prompt for a
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
2008-10-08 06:46:51 -04:00
For more details, see the information on following hyperlings
(@pxref{Handling links}).
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a O
@item O
2008-10-05 05:21:18 -04:00
Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a f
@item f
2008-10-05 05:21:18 -04:00
Open the current task's attachment directory.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a F
@item F
2008-10-05 05:21:18 -04:00
Also open the directory, but force using @code{dired} in Emacs.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
2008-10-07 08:28:21 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a d
@item d
Select and delete a single attachment.
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a D
@item D
Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
dired and delete from there.
@end table
@end table
@node Agenda Views, Embedded LaTeX, Capture, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Agenda Views
@cindex agenda views
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
sorted and displayed in an organized way.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org can select items based on various criteria, and display them
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@itemize @bullet
@item
an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
for specific dates,
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
action items,
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-09-17 07:39:24 -04:00
a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties and
TODO state associated with them,
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@item
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
in time-sorted view,
@item
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
a @emph{keyword search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
that contain specified keywords.
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
along, and
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@emph{custom views} that are special tag/keyword searches and
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
combinations of different views.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent
The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
edit these files remotely.
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
@code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
@code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@menu
* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
2008-04-15 05:02:10 -04:00
* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Agenda files
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex agenda files
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex files for agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
files}, the files listed in the variable
@code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
of the list.
2008-01-31 05:37:13 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Thus even if you only work with a single Org file, this file should
2008-01-31 05:37:13 -05:00
be put into that list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
@kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
@cindex files, adding to agenda list
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c [
@item C-c [
Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C-c ]
@item C-c ]
Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
@kindex C-,
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-'
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item C-,
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@itemx C-'
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
2008-04-14 01:47:32 -04:00
@kindex M-x org-iswitchb
@item M-x org-iswitchb
Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
buffers.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent
The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
to visit any of them.
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily onto a file not in
this list, or onto just one file in the list or even only a subtree in a
file, this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
(@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
extended period, use the following commands:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x <
@item C-c C-x <
Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
2008-12-12 08:38:19 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-x >
@item C-c C-x >
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
@end table
@noindent
When working with @file{Speedbar}, you can use the following commands in
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
the Speedbar frame:
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex <
@item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
Permanently restrict the agenda to the item at the cursor in the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Speedbar frame, either an Org file or a subtree in such a file.
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
effect immediately.
2008-12-12 08:38:19 -05:00
@kindex >
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
Lift the restriction again.
@end table
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section The agenda dispatcher
@cindex agenda dispatcher
@cindex dispatching agenda commands
The views are created through a dispatcher that should be bound to a
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
global key, for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@item a
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@item t @r{/} T
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@item m @r{/} M
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
tags and properties}).
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@item L
Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
@item s
Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
2008-01-31 05:36:42 -05:00
@item /
Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
the files listed in @code{org-agenda-multi-occur-extra-files}. This
uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
1.
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
@item # @r{/} !
Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@item <
Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
selecting the command.
@item < <
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
current buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
character selecting the command.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@section The built-in agenda views
In this section we describe the built-in views.
@menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
* Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@subsection The weekly/daily agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex agenda
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex weekly agenda
@cindex daily agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
@cindex org-agenda, command
@kindex C-c a a
@item C-c a a
2008-10-12 01:35:19 -04:00
Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of org files. The agenda
shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
commands}.
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex calendar integration
@cindex diary integration
Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
the diary.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
agenda, you only need to customize the variable
@lisp
(setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
@end lisp
@noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
entries including holidays, anniversaries etc will be included in the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
between calendar and agenda.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
the left margin, no white space is allowed before them. For example,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
will be made in the agenda:
@example
* Birthdays and similar stuff
#+CATEGORY: Holiday
%%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
#+CATEGORY: Ann
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
%%(diary-anniversary 14 5 1956) Arthur Dent is %d years old
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
%%(diary-anniversary 2 10 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
@end example
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@subsubheading Appointment reminders
@cindex @file{appt.el}
@cindex appointment reminders
Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility.
To add all the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
@code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This commands also lets you filter through
the list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific
category or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for
details.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@subsection The global TODO list
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex global TODO list
@cindex TODO list, global
The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items, formatted and
collected into a single place.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c a t
@item C-c a t
Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate
the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
@kindex C-c a T
@item C-c a T
2008-01-31 05:32:48 -05:00
@cindex TODO keyword matching
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You
can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With
a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as boolean OR
operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in
@code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex r
The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
2008-01-31 05:32:48 -05:00
keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
@cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
it more compact:
@itemize @minus
@item
Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
execution (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}. Configure the
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
variable @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled} to exclude scheduled
items from the global TODO list.
@item
TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
@code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Matching tags and properties
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex matching, of tags
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@cindex matching, of properties
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex tags view
2008-09-17 07:39:24 -04:00
@cindex match view
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags}
(@pxref{Tags}), you can select headlines based on the tags that apply
to them and collect them into an agenda buffer.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c a m
@item C-c a m
Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
@samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
@kindex C-c a M
@item C-c a M
Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items
and force checking subitems (see variable
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). Matching specific TODO keywords
2008-01-31 05:32:48 -05:00
together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
commands}.
2008-03-02 19:06:49 -05:00
@node Timeline, Keyword search, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@subsection Timeline for a single file
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex timeline, single file
@cindex time-sorted view
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
to give an overview over events in a project.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:35:19 -05:00
@kindex C-c a L
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@item C-c a L
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Show a time-sorted view of the org file, with all time-stamped items.
When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
(scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
@noindent
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
@ref{Agenda commands}.
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
@node Keyword search, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
@subsection Keyword search
@cindex keyword search
@cindex searching, for keywords
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
It is particularly useful to find notes.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c a s
@item C-c a s
This is a special search that lets you select entries by keywords or
regular expression, using a boolean logic. For example, the search
string
@example
+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}
@end example
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
@noindent
will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
2008-02-28 13:38:08 -05:00
and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g.
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
2008-03-02 19:06:49 -05:00
@node Stuck projects, , Keyword search, Built-in agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@subsection Stuck projects
If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
projects and define next actions for them.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c a #
@item C-c a #
List projects that are stuck.
@kindex C-c a !
@item C-c a !
Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
project is and how to find it.
@end table
You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
2008-10-12 01:35:19 -04:00
Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
2008-10-12 01:35:19 -04:00
indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
with a tags/todo match @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for
TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that
are not stuck. The correct customization for this is
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-stuck-projects
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
'("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
"\\<IGNORE\\>"))
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@section Presentation and sorting
@cindex presentation, of agenda items
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
(@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
associated with the item.
@menu
* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
@end menu
@node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
@subsection Categories
@cindex category
The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
backward compatibility, the following also works: If there are several
such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
property.}:
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@example
#+CATEGORY: Thesis
@end example
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@noindent
If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
(sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the location
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@noindent
The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
longer than 10 characters.
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Time-of-day specifications
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex time-of-day specification
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
time can be part of the time stamp that triggered inclusion into the
agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
ranges can be specified with two time stamps, like
@c
@w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00
plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
@example
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
@end example
@cindex time grid
If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
@example
8:00...... ------------------
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
10:00...... ------------------
12:00...... ------------------
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
14:00...... ------------------
16:00...... ------------------
18:00...... ------------------
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
20:00...... ------------------
20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
@end example
The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
@code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
@node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
@subsection Sorting of agenda items
@cindex sorting, of agenda items
@cindex priorities, of agenda items
Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
done depends on the type of view.
@itemize @bullet
@item
For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
overdue scheduled or deadline items.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
each category, sorting takes place according to priority
(@pxref{Priorities}).
@item
For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
@end itemize
Sorting can be customized using the variable
2008-04-17 12:26:27 -04:00
@code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Commands in the agenda buffer
@cindex commands, in agenda buffer
Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the org file or diary
file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
original entry location, and to edit the org-files ``remotely'' from
the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
@table @kbd
@tsubheading{Motion}
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex motion commands in agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex n
@item n
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex p
@item p
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@tsubheading{View/Go to org file}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex mouse-3
@kindex @key{SPC}
@item mouse-3
@itemx @key{SPC}
Display the original location of the item in another window.
2008-12-18 03:22:21 -05:00
With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
outline, not only the heading.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex L
@item L
Display original location and recenter that window.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex mouse-2
@kindex mouse-1
@kindex @key{TAB}
@item mouse-2
@itemx mouse-1
@itemx @key{TAB}
Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex @key{RET}
@itemx @key{RET}
Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex f
@item f
Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
2008-01-31 05:31:27 -05:00
location in the org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
agenda buffers can be set with the variable
@code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@kindex b
@item b
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
previously used indirect buffer.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex l
@item l
Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that where marked DONE while
2008-11-05 11:26:52 -05:00
logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
types that should be included in log mode using the variable
@code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
2008-11-09 02:17:33 -05:00
all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
2008-04-04 17:44:48 -04:00
@c
2008-06-19 18:20:12 -04:00
@kindex v
@item v
Toggle Archives mode. In archives mode, trees that are marked are also
scanned when producing the agenda. When you call this command with a
@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, even all archive files are included. To exit
archives mode, press @kbd{v} again.
@c
2008-04-04 17:44:48 -04:00
@kindex R
@item R
Toggle Clockreport mode. In clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
agenda buffers can be set with the variable
2008-04-17 12:26:27 -04:00
@code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Change display}
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex display changing, in agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex o
@item o
Delete other windows.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex d
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@kindex w
@kindex m
@kindex y
@item d w m y
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
2008-03-20 03:42:41 -04:00
month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
@kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex D
@item D
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
@kindex G
@item G
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex r
@item r
Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes
after modification of the time stamps of items with S-@key{left} and
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
S-@key{right}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
keyword.
2008-01-31 10:04:26 -05:00
@kindex g
@item g
Same as @kbd{r}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:32:16 -05:00
@kindex s
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@kindex C-x C-s
2008-01-31 05:32:16 -05:00
@item s
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@itemx C-x C-s
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex @key{right}
@item @key{right}
Display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days. For example, if
the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix
arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex @key{left}
@item @key{left}
Display the previous dates.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex .
@item .
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
Go to today.
2008-04-04 06:25:59 -04:00
@c
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
@item C-c C-x C-c
Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
@code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
@code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-09-05 13:02:14 -04:00
@tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
2008-10-20 03:38:23 -04:00
@cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
@cindex tag filtering, in agenda
@cindex effort filtering, in agenda
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
@cindex query editing, in agenda
2008-09-05 13:02:14 -04:00
@kindex /
@item /
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
The difference between this and a custom agenda commands is that filtering is
very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
having to recreate the agenda.
You will be prompted for a tag selection letter. Pressing @key{TAB} at that
prompt will offer use completion to select a tag (including any tags that do
not have a selection character). The command then hides all entries that do
not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg, remove the
entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second @kbd{/} at the prompt will
turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. If the first key you
press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter will be narrowed by
requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag. Instead of pressing
2008-11-21 13:16:18 -05:00
@kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also immediately use the @kbd{\}
command.
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
efforts globally, for example
@lisp
(setq org-global-properties
'(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
@end lisp
You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of @kbd{<},
@kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort estimate in
your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value. The filter
will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or
larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used as
fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit directly
without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed.
2008-10-20 03:38:23 -04:00
@kindex \
@item \
2008-10-20 17:01:23 -04:00
Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
@kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
2008-09-05 13:02:14 -04:00
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
@kindex [
@kindex ]
@kindex @{
@kindex @}
@item [ ] @{ @}
2008-09-05 13:02:14 -04:00
In the @i{search view} (@pxref{Keyword search}), these keys add new search
words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions (@kbd{@{} and
@kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will add a positive
search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search term @i{must}
occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a negative
search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
selected.
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Remote editing}
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex remote editing, from agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item 0-9
Digit argument.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@cindex undoing remote-editing events
@cindex remote editing, undo
@kindex C-_
@item C-_
Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex t
@item t
Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
original org file.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
@kindex C-k
@item C-k
Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
@kindex a
@item a
Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
@c
@kindex A
@item A
2008-05-01 03:52:45 -04:00
Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{Archive
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
Sibling}.
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:09 -05:00
@kindex $
@item $
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
2008-05-01 03:52:45 -04:00
entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
different file.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex T
@item T
2008-11-27 03:25:50 -05:00
Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
tags of a headline occasionally.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex :
@item :
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex ,
@item ,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
is removed from the entry.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex P
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@item P
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Display weighted priority of current item.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex +
@kindex S-@key{up}
@item +
@itemx S-@key{up}
Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
key for this.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex -
@kindex S-@key{down}
@item -
@itemx S-@key{down}
Decrease the priority of the current item.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-a
@item C-c C-a
Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
@c
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-s
@item C-c C-s
Schedule this item
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-d
@item C-c C-d
Set a deadline for this item.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-06-16 10:26:30 -04:00
@kindex k
@item k
Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
additonal key:
@example
m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
@r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
r @r{Call @code{org-remember} with the cursor date as default date.}
@end example
Press @kbd{r} afterwards to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
command.
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{right}
@item S-@key{right}
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day into the
future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. The stamp is
changed in the original org file, but the change is not directly reflected in
the agenda buffer. Use the @kbd{r} key to update the buffer.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S-@key{left}
@item S-@key{left}
Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day
into the past.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex >
@item >
Change the time stamp associated with the current line to today.
The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.}
on my keyboard.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex I
@item I
Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
is stopped first.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex O
@item O
Stop the previously started clock.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@kindex X
@item X
Cancel the currently running clock.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
@kindex J
@item J
Jump to the running clock in another window.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Calendar commands}
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex calendar commands, from agenda
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex c
@item c
Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item c
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
date at the cursor.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:32:03 -05:00
@cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
@kindex i
@item i
Insert a new entry into the diary. Prompts for the type of entry
(day, weekly, monthly, yearly, anniversary, cyclic) and creates a new
entry in the diary, just as @kbd{i d} etc. would do in the calendar.
The date is taken from the cursor position.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex M
@item M
2008-01-31 05:30:56 -05:00
Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex S
@item S
Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
with calendar variables, see documentation of the Emacs calendar.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex C
@item C
Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
calendars.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex H
@item H
Show holidays for three month around the cursor date.
2008-04-04 06:25:59 -04:00
@item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
2008-04-04 06:25:59 -04:00
This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
@kindex C-x C-w
@item C-x C-w
@cindex exporting agenda views
@cindex agenda views, exporting
Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
@file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), or
plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print}
and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
@kindex q
@item q
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@kindex x
@cindex agenda files, removing buffers
@item x
Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
visit org files will not be removed.
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
2008-04-15 05:02:10 -04:00
@node Custom agenda views, Agenda column view, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@section Custom agenda views
@cindex custom agenda views
@cindex agenda views, custom
Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
@menu
* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
* Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end menu
@node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
@subsection Storing searches
The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
buffer).
@kindex C-c a C
Custom commands are configured in the variable
@code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
search types:
@lisp
@group
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("w" todo "WAITING")
("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end group
@end lisp
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
therefore define:
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@table @kbd
@item C-c a w
as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
keyword
@item C-c a W
as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
results as a sparse tree
@item C-c a u
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
@samp{:urgent:}
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@item C-c a v
as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
headlines that are also TODO items
@item C-c a U
as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
displaying the result as a sparse tree
@item C-c a f
to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
containing the word @samp{FIXME}
@item C-c a h
as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end table
@node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
@subsection Block agenda
@cindex block agenda
@cindex agenda, with block views
Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
@code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
@lisp
@group
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
2008-03-06 09:48:14 -05:00
((agenda "")
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden")))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
2008-03-06 09:48:14 -05:00
((agenda "")
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office")))))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end group
@end lisp
@noindent
This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
@samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@node Setting Options, Exporting Agenda Views, Block agenda, Custom agenda views
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Setting options for custom commands
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@cindex options, for custom agenda views
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
@lisp
@group
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("w" todo "WAITING"
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
(org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
((org-show-following-heading nil)
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
(org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
("N" search ""
((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
(org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end group
@end lisp
@noindent
Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
@kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
2008-02-29 08:49:06 -05:00
will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
to only a single file.
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
For command sets creating a block agenda,
@code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
@code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
@lisp
@group
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
((agenda)
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden"
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
((agenda)
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office")))))
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@end group
@end lisp
As you see, the values and parenthesis setting is a little complex.
When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable - it
fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: When setting options in
this interface, the @emph{values} are just lisp expressions. So if the
value is a string, you need to add the double quotes around the value
yourself.
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Exporting Agenda Views, Using the agenda elsewhere, Setting Options, Custom agenda views
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@subsection Exporting Agenda Views
@cindex agenda views, exporting
If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
install Hrvoje Niksic' @file{htmlize.el}.} postscript, and iCalendar
files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-x C-w
@item C-x C-w
@cindex exporting agenda views
@cindex agenda views, exporting
Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
@file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}),
iCalendar (extension @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension).
Use the variable @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to
set options for @file{ps-print} and for @file{htmlize} to be used during
export, for example
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
'((ps-number-of-columns 2)
(ps-landscape-mode t)
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
(htmlize-output-type 'css)))
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@end lisp
@end table
If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
@footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
that first does define custom commands for the agenda and the global
todo list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
or absolute.
@lisp
@group
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
2008-03-06 09:48:14 -05:00
((agenda "")
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "home")
(tags "garden"))
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
nil
("~/views/home.html"))
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
((agenda)
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(tags-todo "work")
(tags "office"))
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
nil
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@end group
@end lisp
The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
@file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
limit the export to entries listed in the agenda now. Any other
extension produces a plain ASCII file.
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
files in one step:
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c a e
@item C-c a e
2008-03-09 07:44:47 -04:00
Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
them.
@end table
You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
set options for the export commands. For example:
@lisp
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
'(("X" agenda ""
((ps-number-of-columns 2)
(ps-landscape-mode t)
(org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
(org-agenda-with-colors nil)
(org-agenda-remove-tags t))
("theagenda.ps"))))
@end lisp
@noindent
This command sets two options for the postscript exporter, to make it
print in two columns in landscape format - the resulting page can be cut
in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
@noindent
From the command line you may also use
@example
emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
@end example
@noindent
2008-10-19 14:28:25 -04:00
or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting may depend on the
system you use, please check th FAQ for examples.}
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@example
emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
org-agenda-ndays 30 \
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
-kill
@end example
@noindent
which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
@file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with 30 days
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
extent.
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Using the agenda elsewhere, , Exporting Agenda Views, Custom agenda views
@subsection Using agenda information outside of Org
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@cindex agenda, pipe
@cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
line in emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
@code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
current TODO list, you could use
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
@example
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
tags/todo match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
(all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
@samp{NewYork}), you could use
@example
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
@end example
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
@noindent
You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
@example
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
org-agenda-ndays 30 \
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
| lpr
@end example
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
which will produce a 30 day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
@file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
are:
@example
category @r{The category of the item}
head @r{The headline, without TODO kwd, TAGS and PRIORITY}
type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
todo @r{selected in TODO match}
tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
diary @r{imported from diary}
deadline @r{a deadline}
scheduled @r{scheduled}
timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
closed @r{entry was closed on date}
upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
block @r{entry has date block including date}
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
extra @r{String with extra planning info}
priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
@end example
@noindent
Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
lead to the selection of the item.
A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post processing script.
For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
2008-01-31 05:34:34 -05:00
@example
@group
#!/usr/bin/perl
# define the Emacs command to run
$cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
# run it and capture the output
$agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
# loop over all lines
foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
# get the individual values
($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
$priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
# proccess and print
print "[ ] $head\n";
@}
@end group
@end example
2008-04-15 05:02:10 -04:00
@node Agenda column view, , Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
@section Using column view in the agenda
@cindex column view, in agenda
@cindex agenda, column view
Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
collected by certain criteria.
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
@item C-c C-x C-c
Turn on column view in the agenda.
@end table
To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
This causes the following issues:
@enumerate
@item
Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
currently set, and if yes takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in it's file), it
uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
@item
If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and it's @emph{child}). In these
cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
some values will count double.
@item
When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
a column listing the planned total effort for a task - one of the major
applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
the agenda).
@end enumerate
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Embedded LaTeX, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@chapter Embedded LaTeX
@cindex @TeX{} interpretation
@cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
If you observe a few conventions, Org mode knows how to find it and what
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
to do with it.
@menu
* Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
* Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
@end menu
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Math symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@section Math symbols
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex math symbols
@cindex TeX macros
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha}
to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow.
Completion for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a
few letters, and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions.
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Unlike La@TeX{} code, Org mode allows these macros to be present
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
without surrounding math delimiters, for example:
@example
Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
@end example
During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), these symbols are translated
into the proper syntax for HTML, for the above examples this is
2008-09-01 10:50:34 -04:00
@samp{α} and @samp{→}, respectively. If you need such a symbol
inside a word, terminate it like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Math symbols, Embedded LaTeX
@section Subscripts and superscripts
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex subscript
@cindex superscript
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
with curly braces. For example
@example
The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
@end example
To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote
@samp{^} and @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\_} and @samp{\^}.
During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), subscript and superscripts
are surrounded with @code{<sub>} and @code{<sup>} tags, respectively.
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@node LaTeX fragments, Processing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@section LaTeX fragments
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex LaTeX fragments
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
2008-01-31 05:32:41 -05:00
it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
formula processor. To this end, Org mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@itemize @bullet
@item
Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
@code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
whitespace.
@item
Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
2009-01-06 06:56:30 -05:00
currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
@samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@end itemize
@noindent For example:
@example
\begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
\end@{equation@} % etc
If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
@end example
@noindent
If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
@node Processing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
@section Processing LaTeX fragments
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce a preview images of the
typeset expressions:
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x C-l
@item C-c C-x C-l
Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
process the entire buffer.
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
Remove the overlay preview images.
@end table
During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
setting is active:
@lisp
(setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
@end lisp
@node CDLaTeX mode, , Processing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
@section Using CDLaTeX to enter math
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex CDLaTeX
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
major La@TeX{} mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
AUCTeX) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
Don't use CDLaTeX mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org files with
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@lisp
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
@end lisp
When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode):
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@itemize @bullet
@kindex C-c @{
@item
Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
@item
@kindex @key{TAB}
The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
@code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
@item
@kindex _
@kindex ^
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
@code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
@item
@kindex `
Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
@item
@kindex '
Pressing the normal quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
is normal.
@end itemize
@node Exporting, Publishing, Embedded LaTeX, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Exporting
@cindex exporting
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
simple version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
notes file on the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
exchange with a broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
you use Org mode and its structured editing functions to easily create
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
La@TeX{} files. To incorporate entries with associated times like
deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
Org mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
enabled (default in Emacs 23).
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@menu
* Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Export options:: Per-file export settings
* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
* ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
@end menu
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
@node Markup rules, Selective export, Exporting, Exporting
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@section Markup rules
When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since
export targets like HTML or La@TeX{} allow much richer formatting, Org mode
has rules how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the
markup rule used in an Org mode buffer.
@menu
* Document title:: How the document title is determined
* Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
* Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
* Initial text:: Text before the first headline
* Lists:: Plain lists are exported
* Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
* Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
* Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
* Footnote markup::
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
* TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
* Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
* Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
@end menu
@node Document title, Headings and sections, Markup rules, Markup rules
@subheading Document title
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex document title, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@noindent
The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
@example
#+TITLE: This is the title of the document
@end example
@noindent
If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
title will be the file name without extension.
If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
2008-05-20 13:22:00 -04:00
of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Markup rules
@subheading Headings and sections
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex headings and sections, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
Structure} forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
switch, globally by setting the variable @code{org-headline-levels}, or on a
per file basis with a line
@example
#+OPTIONS: H:4
@end example
@node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Markup rules
@subheading Table of contents
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex table of contents, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number or turn off
the table of contents entirely by configuring the variable
@code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
@example
#+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
#+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
@end example
@node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Markup rules
@subheading Text before the first headline
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex text before first headline, markup rules
@cindex #+TEXT
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
you need to include literal HTML or La@TeX{} code, use the special constructs
described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
@code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
@noindent
If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
@code{#+TEXT} construct:
@example
#+OPTIONS: skip:t
#+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
#+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
#+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
@end example
@node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Markup rules
@subheading Lists
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex lists, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists} are translated to the back-ends
syntax for such lists. Most back-ends support unordered, ordered, and
description lists.
@node Paragraphs, Literal examples, Lists, Markup rules
@subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex paragraphs, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
2008-05-13 09:57:23 -04:00
To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
@example
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+BEGIN_VERSE
2008-08-09 13:32:01 -04:00
Great clouds overhead
Tiny black birds rise and fall
Snow covers Emacs
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
2008-08-09 13:32:01 -04:00
-- AlexSchroeder
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+END_VERSE
2008-05-13 09:57:23 -04:00
@end example
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
@example
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+BEGIN_QUOTE
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Everything should be made as simple as possible,
but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+END_QUOTE
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@end example
2008-05-13 09:57:23 -04:00
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
@node Literal examples, Include files, Paragraphs, Markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@subheading Literal examples
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex literal examples, markup rules
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
@cindex code line refenences, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
for source code and similar examples.
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@example
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Some example from a text file.
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+END_EXAMPLE
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@end example
For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the example
2009-01-09 02:28:43 -05:00
lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
whitespace before the colon:
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@example
2009-01-09 02:28:43 -05:00
Here is an example
: Some example from a text file.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@end example
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex formatting source code, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works only for
the HTML back-end, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
later.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to
specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
example:
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@example
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
(defun org-xor (a b)
"Exclusive or."
(if a (not b) b))
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+END_SRC
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@end example
2008-12-25 05:06:35 -05:00
Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference
name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hoovering the mouse over such
a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
cool. If the example/src snippet is numbered, you can also add a @code{-r}
switch. Then labels will be @i{removed} from the source code and the links
will be @i{replaced}@footnote{If you want to explain the use of such labels
themelves in org-mode example code, you can use the @code{-k} switch to make
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
sure they are not touched.} with line numbers from the code listing. Here is
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
an example:
2008-12-25 05:06:35 -05:00
@example
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
(save-excursion (ref:sc)
(goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
#+END SRC
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current positon. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
jumps to point-min.
2008-12-25 05:06:35 -05:00
@end example
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
@code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
-n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
2008-05-25 03:07:23 -04:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c '
@item C-c '
Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
switching to an indirect buffer, narrowing the buffer and switching to the
2008-10-05 05:21:18 -04:00
other mode. You need to exit by pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon
exit, lines starting with @samp{*} or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to
keep them from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special
comments. These commas will be striped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and
also for export.}. Fixed-width
2008-09-05 07:37:33 -04:00
regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be
edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with
the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating
ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
fixed-width region.
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
@kindex C-c l
@item C-c l
Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
2009-01-05 07:23:42 -05:00
that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
2008-05-25 03:07:23 -04:00
@end table
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
@node Include files, Tables exported, Literal examples, Markup rules
@subheading Include files
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex include files, markup rules
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
include your .emacs file, you could use:
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+INCLUDE
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
@example
2008-05-14 08:21:17 -04:00
#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
@end example
The optional second and third parameter are the markup (@samp{quote},
@samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
2008-07-02 16:29:45 -04:00
processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
first line and for each following line. For example, to include a file as an
item, use
@example
#+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
@end example
2008-05-07 07:57:00 -04:00
2008-05-27 02:08:28 -04:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c '
@item C-c '
Visit the include file at point.
@end table
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@node Tables exported, Inlined images, Include files, Markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@subheading Tables
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex tables, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to asssign
a caption and a label for cross references:
@example
#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
#+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
@end example
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@node Inlined images, Footnote markup, Tables exported, Markup rules
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@subheading Inlined Images
@cindex inlined images, markup rules
Some backends (HTML and LaTeX) allow to directly include images into the
exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have
a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}. If you wish to
define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross
references, you can use (before, but close to the link)
@example
#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
@end example
You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
information.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Inlined images, Markup rules
@subheading Footnote markup
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex footnotes, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@cindex @file{footnote.el}
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
Footnotes defined in the way descriped in @ref{Footnotes} will be exported by
all backends. Org does allow multiple references to the same note, and
different backends support this to varying degree.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
@node Emphasis and monospace, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Footnote markup, Markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@subheading Emphasis and monospace
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex underlined text, markup rules
@cindex bold text, markup rules
@cindex italic text, markup rules
@cindex verbatim text, markup rules
@cindex code text, markup rules
@cindex strike-through text, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
syntax, it is exported verbatim.
@node TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Horizontal rules, Emphasis and monospace, Markup rules
@subheading @TeX{} macros and La@TeX{} fragments
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex LaTeX fragments, markup rules
@cindex TeX macros, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@cindex HTML entities
@cindex LaTeX entities
A @TeX{}-like syntax is used to specify special characters. Where possible,
these will be transformed into the native format of the exporter back-end.
Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as @code{α} in the HTML
output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{} output. Similarly,
@code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and @code{~} in La@TeX{}.
This applies for a large number of entities, with names taken from both HTML
and La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-html-entities} for the complete
list. If you are unsure about a name, use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} for completion
2009-01-06 00:31:41 -05:00
after having typed the backslash and maybe a few characters
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
(@pxref{Completion}).
La@TeX{} fragments are converted into images for HTML export, and they are
written literally into the La@TeX{} export. See also @ref{Embedded LaTeX}.
Finally, @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
@samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
different lengths or a compact set of dots.
@node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Markup rules
@subheading Horizontal rules
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
@node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Markup rules
@subheading Comment lines
@cindex comment lines
@cindex exporting, not
2008-05-13 09:57:23 -04:00
Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
never be exported. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
@samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
2008-05-18 06:29:09 -04:00
@samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c ;
@item C-c ;
Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
@end table
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
@node Selective export, Export options, Markup rules, Exporting
@section Selective export
@cindex export, selective by tags
You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
@code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
@noindent
If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
export.
@noindent
Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
be removed from the export buffer.
@node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@section Export options
@cindex options, for export
@cindex completion, of option keywords
The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
(@pxref{Completion}).
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-e t
@item C-c C-e t
Insert template with export options, see example below.
@end table
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+TITLE:
@cindex #+AUTHOR:
@cindex #+DATE:
@cindex #+EMAIL:
@cindex #+LANGUAGE:
@cindex #+TEXT:
@cindex #+OPTIONS:
@cindex #+LINK_UP:
@cindex #+LINK_HOME:
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
@cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:
@cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@example
#+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
#+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
#+DATE: A date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
#+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
#+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
#+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
#+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
#+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
#+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
#+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
#+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
#+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@end example
@noindent
The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
you can:
@cindex headline levels
@cindex section-numbers
@cindex table of contents
@cindex line-break preservation
@cindex quoted HTML tags
@cindex fixed-width sections
@cindex tables
@cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
@cindex footnotes
@cindex special strings
@cindex emphasized text
@cindex @TeX{} macros
@cindex La@TeX{} fragments
@cindex author info, in export
@cindex time info, in export
@example
H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
\n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation}
@@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
:: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
|: @r{turn on/off tables}
^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
@r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
@r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
-: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
<: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
*: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
2008-07-24 15:58:47 -04:00
creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
@end example
These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
@code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
@code{EXPORT_TEXT}, and @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@node The export dispatcher, ASCII export, Export options, Exporting
@section The export dispatcher
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex dispatcher, for export commands
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
the subtrees are exported.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-e
@item C-c C-e
Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
2008-11-20 01:49:36 -05:00
command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
2008-11-20 08:50:06 -05:00
@kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
2008-11-20 01:49:36 -05:00
separate emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-e v
@item C-c C-e v
Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
(i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
2008-04-14 01:47:32 -04:00
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
@item C-u C-u C-c C-e
2008-04-14 08:59:37 -04:00
Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
@code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if st.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@end table
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@node ASCII export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section ASCII export
@cindex ASCII export
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
file.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex region, active
@cindex active region
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
@cindex transient-mark-mode
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e a
@item C-c C-e a
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
Export as ASCII file. For an org file @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
@code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
@code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
export.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v a
@item C-c C-e v a
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
Export only the visible part of the document.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
2008-01-31 04:51:19 -05:00
will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
indentation than the first, these are left alone.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII export, Exporting
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section HTML export
@cindex HTML export
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
language, but with additional support for tables.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@menu
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Images in HTML export::
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
* Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@subsection HTML export commands
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex region, active
@cindex active region
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
@cindex transient-mark-mode
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e h
@item C-c C-e h
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an org file @file{myfile.org},
the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
@code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
property, that name will be used for the export.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e b
@item C-c C-e b
2008-01-31 05:35:45 -05:00
Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e H
@item C-c C-e H
Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e R
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item C-c C-e R
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v h
@kindex C-c C-e v b
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v H
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v R
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@item C-c C-e v h
@item C-c C-e v b
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@item C-c C-e v H
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@item C-c C-e v R
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
Export only the visible part of the document.
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@item M-x org-export-region-as-html
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org mode
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
buffer.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
code.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@noindent
creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@node Quoting HTML tags, Links, HTML Export commands, HTML export
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@subsection Quoting HTML tags
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
@samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
@samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
the exported file use either
@example
#+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
@end example
@noindent or
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
@example
#+BEGIN_HTML
All lines between these markers are exported literally
#+END_HTML
@end example
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@node Links, Images in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@subsection Links
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@cindex links, in HTML export
@cindex internal links, in HTML export
@cindex external links, in HTML export
2009-01-08 16:35:57 -05:00
Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
does include automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
@file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
2008-07-24 09:42:03 -04:00
If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
@code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that wil be added to the
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{alt} and
@code{title} attributes for an inlined image:
2008-07-24 09:42:03 -04:00
@example
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
#+ATTR_HTML: alt="This is image A" title="Image with no action"
[[./img/a.jpg]]
2008-07-24 09:42:03 -04:00
@end example
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@node Images in HTML export, CSS support, Links, HTML export
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@subsection Images
@cindex images, inline in HTML
@cindex inlining images in HTML
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
default@footnote{but see the variable
@code{org-export-html-inline-images}}, images are inlined if a link does
not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
@samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
@example
[[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
@end example
@noindent
and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@node CSS support, Javascript support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@subsection CSS support
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@cindex CSS, for HTML export
@cindex HTML export, CSS
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
2008-12-26 11:51:14 -05:00
You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
assigns the following special CSS classes to appropriate parts of the
document - your style specifications may change these, in addition to any of
the standard classes like for headlines, tables etc.
@example
.todo @r{TODO keywords}
.done @r{the DONE keyword}
.timestamp @r{time stamp}
.timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a time stamp, like SCHEDULED}
.tag @r{tag in a headline}
.target @r{target for links}
div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
.linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
.code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end example
2008-07-01 19:23:17 -04:00
Each exported files contains a compact default style that defines these
2008-10-28 11:35:51 -04:00
classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
@code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
inclusion of these defaults off, customize
@code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
(for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
individually for each file, you can use
2008-09-28 00:36:43 -04:00
@example
#+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
@end example
@noindent
2008-10-28 11:35:51 -04:00
For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
referring to an external file.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
@c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@node Javascript support, , CSS support, HTML export
@subsection Javascript supported display of web pages
@emph{Sebastian Rose} has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one is
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs.
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
The script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
find the documentation for it at
@url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/org-info.js.html}. We are
serving the script from our site, but if you use it a lot, you might not want
to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local copy on
your own web server.
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
2008-05-18 06:29:09 -04:00
To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
adding a single line to the Org file:
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@example
2008-05-14 03:50:53 -04:00
#+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@end example
@noindent
If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
viewing options:
@example
2008-04-16 04:34:55 -04:00
path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
@r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
@r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
2008-04-16 04:34:55 -04:00
sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
@r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
@r{@code{org-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
2008-04-16 04:34:55 -04:00
@r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-headline-levels}, each}
@r{info/folding section can still contain children headlines.}
toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the toc with @kbd{i}.}
2008-04-16 04:34:55 -04:00
tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
@r{the variables @code{org-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the toc?}
@r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
2008-04-16 04:34:55 -04:00
ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
@r{default), only one such button will be present.}
@end example
You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
@code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@node LaTeX and PDF export, XOXO export, HTML export, Exporting
@section LaTeX and PDF export
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@cindex LaTeX export
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@cindex PDF export
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
Org mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
further processing, this backend is also used to produce PDF output. Since
the LaTeX output uses @file{hyperref} to implement links and cross
references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@menu
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invode which commands
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@end menu
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@subsection LaTeX export commands
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
@cindex region, active
@cindex active region
@cindex transient-mark-mode
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-e l
@item C-c C-e l
2008-05-21 03:49:04 -04:00
Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an org file
@file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
2008-12-19 03:13:17 -05:00
be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this
requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
property, that name will be used for the export.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e L
@item C-c C-e L
Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
@kindex C-c C-e v l
@kindex C-c C-e v L
@item C-c C-e v l
@item C-c C-e v L
Export only the visible part of the document.
@item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
buffer.
@item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
code.
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@kindex C-c C-e p
@item C-c C-e p
Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF.
@kindex C-c C-e d
@item C-c C-e d
Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@end table
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
convert them to a custom string depending on
@code{org-latex-low-levels}.
If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
2008-03-30 15:07:05 -04:00
with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@example
@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
@end example
@noindent
creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@node Quoting LaTeX code, Sectioning structure, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@subsection Quoting LaTeX code
Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX} will be correctly
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
inserted into the La@TeX{} file. Furthermore, you can add special code
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with the following
constructs:
@example
#+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
@end example
@noindent or
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@example
#+BEGIN_LaTeX
All lines between these markers are exported literally
#+END_LaTeX
@end example
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
@node Sectioning structure, Tables in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@subsection Sectioning structure
@cindex LaTeX class
@cindex LaTeX sectioning structure
By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
You can change this globally by setting a different value for
2008-10-13 01:26:05 -04:00
@code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
@code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file. The class should be listed in
@code{org-export-latex-classes}, where you can also define the sectioning
structure for each class, as well as defining additonal classes.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
@node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Sectioning structure, LaTeX and PDF export
@subsection Tables in LaTeX export
@cindex tables, in LaTeX export
For LaTeX export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
(@pxref{Tables exported}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
request a longtable environment for the table, so that it may span several
pages:
@example
#+CAPTION: A long table
#+LABEL: tbl:long
#+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable
| ..... | ..... |
| ..... | ..... |
@end example
@node Images in LaTeX export, , Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
@subsection Images in LaTeX export
@cindex images, inline in LaTeX
@cindex inlining images in LaTeX
Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
output files resulting from LaTeX output. Org will use an
@code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
2008-12-15 15:28:02 -05:00
caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Markup rules}, the figure will
Captions and attributes for images and tables during export
Tables, and Hyperlinks that represent inlined images, can now be
equipped with additional information that will be used during
export. The information will be taken from the following special
lines in the buffer and apply to the first following table or
link.
- #+CAPTION: :: The caption of the image or table. This string
should be processed according to the export backend, but
this is not yet done.
- #+LABEL: :: A label to identify the figure/table for cross
references. For HTML export, this string will become the
ID for the `<div class="figure">' element that encapsulates
the image tag and the caption. For LaTeX export, this
string will be used as the argument of a `\label{...}'
macro. These lables will be available for internal links
like `[[label][Table] ]'.
- #+ATTR_HTML: :: Attributes for HTML export of image, to be
added as attributes into the `<img...>' tag. This string
will not be processed, so it should have immediately the
right format.
- #+ATTR_LaTeX: :: Attributes for LaTeX export of images, to
be inserted into the optional argument of the
`\includegraphics[...]{file}' command, to specify scaling,
clipping and other options. This string will not be
processed, so it should have immediately the right
format, like `width=5cm,angle=90'
For LaTeX export, if either a caption or a label is given, the
element will be exported as a float, i.e. wrapped into a figure
or table environment.
2008-12-10 06:50:07 -05:00
be wrappend into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
element. Finally, you can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the
options that can be used in the optional argument of the
@code{\includegraphics} macro.
@example
#+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
@end example
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
@node XOXO export, iCalendar export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@section XOXO export
@cindex XOXO export
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e x
@item C-c C-e x
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e v
@item C-c C-e v x
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
Export only the visible part of the document.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@end table
2008-05-06 03:32:16 -04:00
@node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@section iCalendar export
@cindex iCalendar export
2008-06-23 03:08:08 -04:00
Some people like to use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still
prefer a standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments.
In this case it can be useful to have deadlines and other time-stamped items
in Org files show up in the calendar application. Org mode can export
calendar information in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to
have TODO entries included in the export, configure the variable
@code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. iCalendar export will export plain time
stamps as VEVENT, and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from
deadlines that are in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO
items will be used to set the start and due dates for the todo
entry@footnote{See the variables @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and
2008-09-18 11:35:55 -04:00
@code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}. As categories, it will use the tags
locally defined in the heading, and the file/tree category@footnote{To add
inherited tags or the TODO state, configure the variable
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
2008-05-19 02:22:51 -04:00
The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
@code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e i
@item C-c C-e i
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e I
@item C-c C-e I
Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
file will be written.
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-e c
@item C-c C-e c
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
@code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
@code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
@end table
2008-12-03 02:28:26 -05:00
The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
@code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
and the description from the body (limited to
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
2008-01-31 05:36:29 -05:00
2008-06-23 03:08:08 -04:00
How this calendar is best read and updated, that depends on the application
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top
@chapter Publishing
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org includes@footnote{@file{org-publish.el} is not distributed with
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
Emacs 21, if you are still using Emacs 21, you need you need to download
this file separately.} a publishing management system that allows you to
configure automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
interlinked org files. This system is called @emph{org-publish}. You can
also configure org-publish to automatically upload your exported HTML
pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
a web server. Org-publish turns Org into a web-site authoring tool.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
You can also use Org-publish to convert files into La@TeX{}, or even
combine HTML and La@TeX{} conversion so that files are available in both
formats on the server@footnote{Since La@TeX{} files on a server are not
that helpful, you surely want to perform further conversion on them --
e.g. convert them to @code{PDF} format.}.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org-publish has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@menu
* Configuration:: Defining projects
* Sample configuration:: Example projects
* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
@end menu
@node Configuration, Sample configuration, Publishing, Publishing
@section Configuration
Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
and many other properties of a project.
@menu
* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex org-publish-project-alist
@cindex projects, for publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Org-publish is configured almost entirely through setting the value of
one variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of
the two following forms:
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@r{or}
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values.
A project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as
the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When
a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members
of the ``components'' property are taken to be components of the
project, which group together files requiring different publishing
options. When you publish such a ``meta-project'' all the components
2008-11-25 04:56:37 -05:00
will also publish. The @code{:components} are published in the sequence
provided.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@subsection Sources and destinations for files
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex directories, for publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
particular, org-publish needs to know where to look for source files,
and where to put published files.
@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
@item @code{:base-directory}
@tab Directory containing publishing source files
@item @code{:publishing-directory}
@tab Directory (possibly remote) where output files will be published.
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
@item @code{:preparation-function}
2008-06-15 02:03:45 -04:00
@tab Function called before starting the publishing process, for example to
2008-01-31 05:32:41 -05:00
run @code{make} for updating files to be published.
2008-06-15 02:03:45 -04:00
@item @code{:completion-function}
@tab Function called after finishing the publishing process, for example to
change permissions of the resulting files.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end multitable
@noindent
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@subsection Selecting files
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex files, selecting for publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
properties
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
@item @code{:base-extension}
@tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
regular expression.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item @code{:exclude}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
extension.
@item @code{:include}
@tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
and @code{:exclude}.
@end multitable
@node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@subsection Publishing action
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex action, for publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
2008-10-15 11:21:52 -04:00
possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
@code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
export}). But you also can publish your files in La@TeX{} by using the
function @code{org-publish-org-to-latex} instead, or as PDF files using
@code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. Other files like images only need to be
copied to the publishing destination. For non-Org files, you need to provide
your own publishing function:
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
@item @code{:publishing-function}
2008-01-31 05:32:41 -05:00
@tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end multitable
The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at
least a @code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
to be published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
You can write your own publishing function, but @code{org-publish}
provides one for attachments (files that only need to be copied):
@code{org-publish-attachment}.
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@subsection Options for the HTML/LaTeX exporters
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex options, for publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
respective variable for details.
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
@item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
@item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
@item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
@item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
@item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
@item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
@item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
@item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
2008-06-26 00:04:44 -04:00
@item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
@item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
@item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
@item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
2008-10-28 11:35:51 -04:00
@item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
2008-06-29 11:20:17 -04:00
@item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
@item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
Better handling of export options.
This patch improves the internal handling of the large number of
export options that Org-mode has. In particular, it now defines a
single constant, `org-export-plist-vars' that contains the full list
of options, and how these can be accessed through variables, and
through the #+OPTIONS line. Before the patch, there used to be a
separate list or the OPTIONS handling, which has gotten out of sync.
This now no longer can happen.
Also, this patch adds two new variables, `org-export-with-priority',
and `org-export-with-todo-keywords', which can be used to turn the
export of TODO keywords and priority cookies on and off, so that these
can simply disappear and not be shown in the exported file. In fact,
the default for the priority cookie is to remove it.
2008-12-03 01:33:05 -05:00
@item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
@item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
@item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
@item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
@item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
@item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
@item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
@item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
@item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
@item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address}
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
@item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
@item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end multitable
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
If you use several email addresses, separate them by a semi-column.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
@code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
La@TeX{} export.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
options}), however, override everything.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@subsection Links between published files
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex links, publishing
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
@samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). Upon publishing this link
becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
you publish them to HTML.
You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are
careful with relative pathnames, and provided you have also configured
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@code{org-publish} to upload the related files, these links will work
2008-12-17 06:10:24 -05:00
too. See @ref{Complex example} for an example of this usage.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Sometime an Org file to be published may contain links that are
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
location. In this case, use the property
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
@item @code{:link-validation-function}
@tab Function to validate links
@end multitable
@noindent
to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@subsection Project page index
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex index, of published pages
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
The following properties may be used to control publishing of an
index of files or summary page for a given project.
@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
@item @code{:auto-index}
@tab When non-nil, publish an index during org-publish-current-project or
org-publish-all.
@item @code{:index-filename}
@tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{index.org} (which
becomes @file{index.html}).
@item @code{:index-title}
@tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file.
@item @code{:index-function}
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@tab Plug-in function to use for generation of index.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list
of links to all files in the project.
@end multitable
@node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Configuration, Publishing
@section Sample configuration
Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
more complex, with a multi-component project.
@menu
* Simple example:: One-component publishing
* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
@end menu
@node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
@subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
directory on the local machine.
@lisp
(setq org-publish-project-alist
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
'(("org"
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
:base-directory "~/org/"
:publishing-directory "~/public_html"
:section-numbers nil
:table-of-contents nil
2008-11-02 11:01:50 -05:00
:style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
type=\"text/css\">")))
@end lisp
@node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
@subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
org files converted to HTML, image files, emacs lisp source code, and
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
style sheets. The publishing-directory is remote and private files are
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
excluded.
To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
paths. For example, if your org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with
@c
@example
file:../images/myimage.png
@end example
@c
On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@lisp
(setq org-publish-project-alist
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
'(("orgfiles"
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
:base-directory "~/org/"
:base-extension "org"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
:publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
:exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
:headline-levels 3
:section-numbers nil
:table-of-contents nil
2008-11-02 11:01:50 -05:00
:style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\">"
:auto-preamble t
:auto-postamble nil)
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
("images"
:base-directory "~/images/"
:base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
("other"
:base-directory "~/other/"
:base-extension "css\\|el"
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end lisp
@node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
@section Triggering publication
Once org-publish is properly configured, you can publish with the
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
following functions:
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
@item C-c C-e C
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
@item C-c C-e P
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
Publish the project containing the current file.
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
@item C-c C-e F
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
Publish only the current file.
2008-01-31 05:34:26 -05:00
@item C-c C-e A
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
Publish all projects.
@end table
Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above
functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
2008-06-12 10:13:16 -04:00
@node Miscellaneous, Extensions, Publishing, Top
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@chapter Miscellaneous
@menu
* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
* Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
@end menu
@node Completion, Customization, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
@section Completion
@cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
@cindex completion, of dictionary words
@cindex completion, of option keywords
@cindex completion, of tags
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@cindex completion, of property keys
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@cindex completion, of link abbreviations
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
@cindex TODO keywords completion
@cindex dictionary word completion
@cindex option keyword completion
@cindex tag completion
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@cindex link abbreviations, completion of
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
@table @kbd
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
@item M-@key{TAB}
Complete word at point
@itemize @bullet
@item
At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
@item
After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
@samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
@item
After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
buffer.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
@item
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
will insert example settings for this keyword.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
i.e. valid keys for this line.
@item
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end itemize
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Customization, In-buffer settings, Completion, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Customization
@cindex customization
@cindex options, for customization
@cindex variables, for customization
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@section Summary of in-buffer settings
@cindex in-buffer settings
@cindex special keywords
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@table @kbd
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
@item #+CATEGORY:
This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
@item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
columns view is invoked in location where no @code{COLUMNS} property
applies.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
The global version of this variable is
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@code{org-table-formula-constants}.
2008-05-19 13:48:52 -04:00
@item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
top-level entries.
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
@code{org-drawers}.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item #+LINK: linkword replace
These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
@xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
@code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
@item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
2008-05-07 10:26:01 -04:00
@item #+SETUPFILE: file
This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
(i.e. when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
as if they had been included in the buffer. In particlar, the file can be
2008-05-27 02:08:28 -04:00
any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@item #+STARTUP:
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
Org file is being visited. The first set of options deals with the
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for
global default settings is @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default
value @code{t}, which means @code{overview}.
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@example
overview @r{top-level headlines only}
content @r{all headlines}
showall @r{no folding at all, show everything}
@end example
Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@code{nil}.
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@example
align @r{align all tables}
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@end example
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
Logging closing and reinstating TODO items, and clock intervals
(variables @code{org-log-done}, @code{org-log-note-clock-out}, and
@code{org-log-repeat}) can be configured using these options.
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
@cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
2008-02-14 13:47:41 -05:00
@cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
@cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
@cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
@cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:34:30 -05:00
@cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@example
2008-02-17 11:00:04 -05:00
logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end example
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
@code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@example
hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
@end example
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
To turn on custom format overlays over time stamps (variables
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
@code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
2008-01-31 05:32:52 -05:00
@example
customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
@end example
2008-01-31 05:34:04 -05:00
The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
@code{constants-unit-system}).
@cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
@example
constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
@end example
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline} and
@code{org-footnote-auto-label}.
@cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{fnnoinline}, STARTUP keyword
2009-01-04 02:53:59 -05:00
@cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
@cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
@cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
@example
fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
2009-01-04 02:53:59 -05:00
fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
2009-01-02 09:53:02 -05:00
fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
@end example
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
2008-02-18 02:27:47 -05:00
These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@item #+TBLFM:
This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+OPTIONS, #+DATE:
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@ref{Export options}.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
current file. The corresponding variables are @code{org-todo-keywords}
and @code{org-todo-interpretation}.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@section The very busy C-c C-c key
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-c
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@cindex C-c C-c, overview
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
other circumstances it means something like @emph{Hey Org, look
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
here and update according to what you see here}. Here is a summary of
what this means in different contexts.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@itemize @minus
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
information.
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@item
If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
the entire table.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package,
activate that table.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
If the current buffer is a remember buffer, close the note and file it.
With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
default location.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
corresponding links in this buffer.
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
drawer, offer property commands.
@item
2008-12-30 17:59:22 -05:00
If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
definition, and vice versa.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
of the checkbox.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
ordered list.
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
@item
If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamical block, the
block is updated.
2008-01-31 05:30:59 -05:00
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:31:08 -05:00
@node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section A cleaner outline view
@cindex hiding leading stars
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@cindex dynamic indentation
@cindex odd-levels-only outlines
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex clean outline view
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines are starting
with a potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines
is not indented. This is not really a problem when you are writing a book
where the outline headings are really section headlines. However, in a more
list-oriented outline, it is clear that an indented structure is a lot
cleaner, as can be seen by comparing the two columns in the following
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
example:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@group
* Top level headline | * Top level headline
** Second level | * Second level
*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
some text | some text
*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
more text | more text
* Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
@end group
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
@noindent
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
It is non-trivial to make such a look work in Emacs, but Org contains three
separate features that, combined, achieve just that.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@enumerate
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@item
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
with the headline, like
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@example
*** 3rd level
more text, now indented
@end example
A good way to get this indentation is by hand, and Org supports this with
paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure editing@footnote{See also the
variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.} preserving or adapting the
indentation appropriate. A different approach would be to have a way to
automatically indent lines according to outline structure by adding overlays
or text properties. But I have not yet found a robust and efficient way to
do this in large files.
@item
@emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
with
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
#+STARTUP: hidestars
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-09-03 05:16:36 -04:00
@noindent
Note that the opposite behavior is selected with @code{showstars}.
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@group
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
* Top level headline
* Second level
* 3rd level
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
...
@end group
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end example
@noindent
Note that the leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they
are only fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
background color as font color. If you are not using either white or
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
black background, you may have to customize this face to get the wanted
effect. Another possibility is to set this font such that the extra
stars are @i{almost} invisible, for example using the color
@code{grey90} on a white background.
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@item
Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
to the next. In this way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of
this section. In order to make the structure editing and export commands
handle this convention correctly, configure the variable
@code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on a per-file basis with one of the
following lines:
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
#+STARTUP: odd
#+STARTUP: oddeven
@end example
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
2008-01-31 05:31:03 -05:00
double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
2008-05-24 05:18:40 -04:00
@end enumerate
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@section Using Org on a tty
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@cindex tty key bindings
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default much of
Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
@key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
customized work-around suits you better. For example, changing a time
stamp is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.2
@item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
@item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab
@item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab
2008-10-23 15:25:46 -04:00
@item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x i} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab
@item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab
@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab
@item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab
@item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab
2008-01-31 05:34:14 -05:00
@item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab
@item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab
@item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab
@item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab
@item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab
@item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end multitable
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Interaction, Bugs, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Interaction with other packages
@cindex packages, interaction with other
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
with other code out there.
@menu
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
@end menu
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@table @asis
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex @file{calc.el}
@item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
@code{calc-eval} which should be autoloaded in your setup if Calc has
been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
, Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex @file{constants.el}
@item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
@samp{Mega} etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
setup. See the installation instructions in the file
@file{constants.el}.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
@cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode can make use of the CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter
La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
@cindex @file{imenu.el}
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
supports Imenu - all you need to do to get the index is the following:
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@lisp
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
2008-04-10 03:00:12 -04:00
(lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@end lisp
By default the index is two levels deep - you can modify the depth using
the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
@cindex @file{remember.el}
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@file{Remember.el} is not part of Emacs, find it on the web.
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
@cindex @file{speedbar.el}
Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows to
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@cindex @file{table.el}
@item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-c C-c
@cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
@cindex @file{table.el}
Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table},
and also part of Emacs 22).
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org mode
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org mode is inactive. In order
to execute Org mode-related commands, leave the table.
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-c
@item C-c C-c
Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a
table.el table.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@c
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
@kindex C-c ~
@item C-c ~
Insert a table.el table. If there is already a table at point, this
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
command converts it between the table.el format and the Org mode
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
format. See the documentation string of the command
@code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
possible.
@end table
@file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22.
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
@cindex @file{footnote.el}
@item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
(@pxref{Footnotes}).
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@end table
@node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@table @asis
@cindex @file{allout.el}
@item @file{allout.el} by Ken Manheimer
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Startup of Org may fail with the error message
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
@code{(wrong-type-argument keymapp nil)} when there is an outdated
version @file{allout.el} on the load path, for example the version
distributed with Emacs 21.x. Upgrade to Emacs 22 and this problem will
disappear. If for some reason you cannot do this, make sure that org.el
is loaded @emph{before} @file{allout.el}, for example by putting
@code{(require 'org)} early enough into your @file{.emacs} file.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex @file{CUA.el}
@item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by
CUA mode (as well as pc-select-mode and s-region-mode) to select and
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
extend the region. If you want to use one of these packages along with
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When
set, Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
in the agenda buffer (but not during date selection).
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@example
S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
@end example
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
@code{org-disputed-keys}.
2008-01-31 05:31:27 -05:00
@item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
@cindex @file{windmove.el}
Also this package uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here.
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
@cindex @file{footnote.el}
@item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org supports the syntax of the footnote package, but only the
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
numerical footnote markers. Also, the default key for footnote
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
commands, @kbd{C-c !} is already used by Org. You could use the
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
variable @code{footnote-prefix} to switch footnotes commands to another
key. Or, you could use @code{org-replace-disputed-keys} and
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@code{org-disputed-keys} to change the settings in Org.
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:34:42 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@node Bugs, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@section Bugs
@cindex bugs
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
Here is a list of things that should work differently, but which I
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
have found too hard to fix.
@itemize @bullet
@item
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
If a table field starts with a link, and if the corresponding table
column is narrowed (@pxref{Narrow columns}) to a width too small to
display the link, the field would look entirely empty even though it is
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
not. To prevent this, Org throws an error. The work-around is to
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
make the column wide enough to fit the link, or to add some text (at
least 2 characters) before the link in the same field.
@item
Narrowing table columns does not work on XEmacs, because the
@code{format} function does not transport text properties.
@item
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
Text in an entry protected with the @samp{QUOTE} keyword should not
autowrap.
@item
When the application called by @kbd{C-c C-o} to open a file link fails
2008-01-31 05:31:37 -05:00
(for example because the application does not exist or refuses to open
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
the file), it does so silently. No error message is displayed.
@item
Recalculating a table line applies the formulas from left to right.
If a formula uses @emph{calculated} fields further down the row,
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
multiple recalculation may be needed to get all fields consistent. You
may use the command @code{org-table-iterate} (@kbd{C-u C-c *}) to
recalculate until convergence.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
The exporters work well, but could be made more efficient.
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-06-12 10:13:16 -04:00
@node Extensions, Hacking, Miscellaneous, Top
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@appendix Extensions
This appendix lists the extension modules that have been written for Org.
Many of these extensions live in the @file{contrib} directory of the Org
distribution, others are available somewhere on the web.
@menu
* Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
* Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
@end menu
2008-06-12 10:13:16 -04:00
@node Extensions in the contrib directory, Other extensions, Extensions, Extensions
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@section Extensions in the @file{contrib} directory
2008-11-20 08:50:06 -05:00
A number of extension are distributed with Org when you download it from its
homepage. Please note that these extensions are @emph{not} distributed as
part of Emacs, so if you use Org as delivered with Emacs, you still need to
go to @url{http://orgmode.org} to get access to these modules.
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@table @asis
@item @file{org-annotate-file.el} by @i{Philip Jackson}
Annotate a file with org syntax, in a separate file, with links back to
the annotated file.
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
@item @file{org-annotation-helper.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry and Daniel E. German}
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
Call @i{remember} directly from Firefox/Opera, or from Adobe Reader.
When activating a special link or bookmark, Emacs receives a trigger to
create a note with a link back to the website. Requires some setup, a
detailes description is in
@file{contrib/packages/org-annotation-helper}.
@item @file{org-bookmark.el} by @i{Tokuya Kameshima}
Support for links to Emacs bookmarks.
@item @file{org-depend.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
TODO dependencies for Org-mode. Make TODO state changes in one entry
trigger changes in another, or be blocked by the state of another
entry. Also, easily create chains of TODO items with exactly one
active item at any time.
@item @file{org-elisp-symbol.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
Org links to emacs-lisp symbols. This can create annotated links that
exactly point to the definition location of a variable of function.
@item @file{org-eval.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
The @code{<lisp>} tag, adapted from Emacs Wiki and Emacs Muse, allows
2008-11-24 05:32:31 -05:00
text to be included in a document that is the result of evaluating some
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
code. Other scripting languages like @code{perl} can be supported with
this package as well.
2008-11-19 11:33:23 -05:00
@item @file{org-eval-light.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
2008-11-20 01:57:24 -05:00
User-controlled evaluation of code in an Org buffer.
2008-11-19 11:33:23 -05:00
@item @file{org-exp-blocks.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
Preprocess user-defined blocks for export.
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@item @file{org-expiry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
Expiry mechanism for Org entries.
@item @file{org-indent.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
Dynamic indentation of Org outlines. The plan is to indent an outline
according to level, but so far this is too hard for a proper and stable
implementation. Still, it works somewhat.
@item @file{org-interactive-query.el} by @i{Christopher League}
Interactive modification of tags queries. After running a general
query in Org, this package allows to narrow down the results by adding
more tags or keywords.
@item @file{org-mairix.el} by @i{Georg C. F. Greve}
Hook mairix search into Org for different MUAs.
@item @file{org-man.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
Support for links to manpages in Org-mode.
@item @file{org-mtags.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
Support for some Muse-like tags in Org-mode. This package allows you
to write @code{<example>} and @code{<src>} and other syntax copied from
Emacs Muse, right inside an Org file. The goal here is to make it easy
to publish the same file using either org-publish or Muse.
@item @file{org-panel.el} by @i{Lennard Borgman}
Simplified and display-aided access to some Org commands.
@item @file{org-registry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
A registry for Org links, to find out from where links point to a given
file or location.
@item @file{org2rem.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
Convert org appointments into reminders for the @file{remind} program.
@item @file{org-screen.el} by @i{Andrew Hyatt}
Visit screen sessions through Org-mode links.
@item @file{org-toc.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
Table of contents in a separate buffer, with fast access to sections
and easy visibility cycling.
@item @file{orgtbl-sqlinsert.el} by @i{Jason Riedy}
Convert Org-mode tables to SQL insertions. Documentation for this can
be found on the Worg pages.
@end table
2008-06-12 10:13:16 -04:00
@node Other extensions, , Extensions in the contrib directory, Extensions
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@section Other extensions
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@i{TO BE DONE}
2008-06-12 10:13:16 -04:00
@node Hacking, History and Acknowledgments, Extensions, Top
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@appendix Hacking
This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@menu
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
* Special agenda views:: Customized views
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@end menu
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@node Adding hyperlink types, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking, Hacking
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@section Adding hyperlink types
@cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
(@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, it
2008-10-12 01:35:19 -04:00
provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@file{org-man.el} that will add support for creating links like
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
emacs:
@lisp
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
(require 'org)
(org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
(add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
(defcustom org-man-command 'man
"The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
:group 'org-link
:type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
(defun org-man-open (path)
"Visit the manpage on PATH.
PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
(funcall org-man-command path))
(defun org-man-store-link ()
"Store a link to a manpage."
(when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
;; This is a man page, we do make this link
(let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
(link (concat "man:" page))
(description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
(org-store-link-props
:type "man"
:link link
:description description))))
(defun org-man-get-page-name ()
"Extract the page name from the buffer name."
;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
(if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
(match-string 1 (buffer-name))
(error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
(provide 'org-man)
;;; org-man.el ends here
@end lisp
@noindent
You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
@lisp
(require 'org-man)
@end lisp
@noindent
2008-10-12 01:35:19 -04:00
Let's go through the file and see what it does.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@enumerate
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
loaded.
@item
The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
that will be called to follow such a link.
@item
The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
buffer displaying a man page.
@end enumerate
The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
First there is a customization variable that determines which emacs
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
defined. It gets the link path as an argument - in this case the link
path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, also this function will be called to
try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
create the link for this buffer type, we do this by checking the value
of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@cindex tables, in other modes
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@cindex lists, in other modes
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex Orgtbl mode
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
editor.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
@i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
for a very flexible system.
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists. You can use Org's
facilities to edit and structure lists by turning @code{orgstruct-mode}
on, then locally exporting such lists in another format (HTML, La@TeX{}
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
or Texinfo.)
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@menu
* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@end menu
@node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
@subsection Radio tables
@cindex radio tables
To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
@example
/* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
/* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
@end example
@noindent
Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
example:
@example
#+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
@end example
@noindent
@code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
passed as a property list to the translation function for
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
acted upon before the translation function is called:
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@table @code
@item :skip N
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
this parameter!
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
additional columns.
@end table
@noindent
The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
number of different solutions:
@itemize @bullet
@item
The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
statement, for example @samp{\bye} in TeX and @samp{\end@{document@}}
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
in La@TeX{}.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
You can just comment the table line by line whenever you want to process
the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
only sounds tedious - the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment} does
make this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
key.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@end itemize
@node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@subsection A LaTeX example of radio tables
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
be prompted for a table name, lets say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
will then get the following template:
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
@cindex #+ORGTBL: SEND
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@example
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\begin@{comment@}
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
| | |
\end@{comment@}
@end example
@noindent
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As shown in the
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
@code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a
much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
@example
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\begin@{comment@}
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|-------+------+---------+---------|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
% $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
\end@{comment@}
@end example
@noindent
When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
table inserted between the two marker lines.
Now lets assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
want to control how columns are aligned etc. In this case we make sure
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
that the table translator does skip the first 2 lines of the source
table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
header and footer commands of the target table:
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@example
\begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
\end@{tabular@}
%
\begin@{comment@}
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|-------+------+---------+---------|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
\end@{comment@}
@end example
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
interprets the following parameters (see also @ref{Translator functions}):
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@table @code
@item :splice nil/t
When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
tabular environment. Default is nil.
@item :fmt fmt
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
A format to be used to wrap each field, should contain @code{%s} for the
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
2008-04-21 01:50:27 -04:00
A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
function must return a formatted string.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@item :efmt efmt
Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
@code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
@code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
@code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
2008-04-21 01:50:27 -04:00
applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
supplied instead of strings.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@end table
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@subsection Translator functions
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@cindex translator function
2008-05-12 01:30:34 -04:00
Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
(comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
@code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
hands over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
@lisp
@group
(defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
"Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
(let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
org-table-last-alignment ""))
(params2
(list
:tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
:tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
:lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
:efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
(orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
@end group
@end lisp
As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
@var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
(variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
overrule the default with
@example
#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
@end example
For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!} and where the field
separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
a single line!):
@example
#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
:lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
@end example
@noindent
Please check the documentation string of the function
@code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
that function and remember that you can pass each of them into
@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
using the generic function.
Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
@samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
translator, please post it on @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
others can benefit from your work.
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
@node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
@subsection Radio lists
@cindex radio lists
@cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than
sending and receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}) @footnote{You
need to load the @code{org-export-latex.el} package to use radio lists
since the relevant code is there for now.}. As for radio tables, you
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
can insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
calling @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
Here are the differences with radio tables:
@itemize @minus
@item
Use @code{ORGLST} instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
@item
The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
parameters.
2008-03-03 20:43:56 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:37:51 -05:00
`C-c C-c' will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
@end itemize
Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
La@TeX{} file:
@example
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
% END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
\begin@{comment@}
#+ORGLIST: SEND to-buy orgtbl-to-latex
- a new house
- a new computer
+ a new keyboard
+ a new mouse
- a new life
\end@{comment@}
@end example
Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@section Dynamic blocks
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@cindex dynamic blocks
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
2008-01-31 05:33:55 -05:00
specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
the content of the block.
2008-05-08 11:16:29 -04:00
#+BEGIN:dynamic block
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@example
2008-01-31 05:32:24 -05:00
#+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
#+END:
@end example
Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
@table @kbd
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
@item C-c C-x C-u
Update dynamic block at point.
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
@end table
Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
2008-03-10 05:26:39 -04:00
writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
extra parameter @code{:content}.
For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
run:
@example
#+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
#+END:
@end example
@noindent
The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:32:20 -05:00
(defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
(let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
(insert "Last block update at: "
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
(format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@end lisp
If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
written in a way that is does nothing in buffers that are not in
@code{org-mode}.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@node Special agenda views, Using the property API, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
2008-03-31 04:56:17 -04:00
@section Special agenda views
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@cindex agenda views, user-defined
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
2008-03-30 10:30:05 -04:00
marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
2008-01-31 05:33:41 -05:00
the subtree belonging to the project line.
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
search should continue from there.
@lisp
(defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
"Skip trees that are not waiting"
(let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
(if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
nil ; tag found, do not skip
subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
like this:
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@lisp
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
2008-11-04 00:55:48 -05:00
((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
@end lisp
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
meaningful header in the agenda view.
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
your custom search function, simply do a search for @samp{LEVEL>0}, and then
use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries you really want to
have.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
@table @code
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
2008-01-31 05:36:18 -05:00
Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
@end table
Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
like this, even without defining a special function:
@lisp
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
2008-01-31 05:38:36 -05:00
'regexp ":waiting:"))
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
@end lisp
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Special agenda views, Hacking
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@section Using the property API
@cindex API, for properties
2008-01-31 05:35:14 -05:00
@cindex properties, API
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
properties.
@defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.
This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
if the property key was used several times.
POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
`special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
@end defun
@defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
2008-03-21 05:34:43 -04:00
Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
@code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
@code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@end defun
@defun org-entry-delete pom property
Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
@end defun
@defun org-entry-put pom property value
Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
@end defun
@defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
Get all property keys in the current buffer.
@end defun
@defun org-insert-property-drawer
Insert a property drawer at point.
@end defun
2008-01-31 05:33:13 -05:00
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
@defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
@end defun
@defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
values and return the values as a list of strings.
@end defun
2008-04-03 09:27:33 -04:00
@defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
@end defun
@defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
@end defun
@defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
values and check if VALUE is in this list.
@end defun
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
@section Using the mapping API
@cindex API, for mapping
@cindex mapping entries, API
Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
is:
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
FUNC is a function or a lisp form. The function will be called without
arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
returned as a list.
2008-09-17 07:39:24 -04:00
MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
visited by the iteration.
SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
@example
nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
file-with-archives
@r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
agenda @r{all agenda files}
agenda-with-archives
@r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
(file1 file2 ...)
@r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
@end example
The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
the scanner. The following items can be given here:
@example
archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
function or Lisp form
@r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
@r{so whenever the the function returns t, FUNC}
@r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
@r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
@end example
@end defun
The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
It can uce the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
information about the entry, or in order to change metadate in the entry.
Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
2008-12-04 09:33:43 -05:00
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@defun org-todo &optional arg
Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
the many possible values for the argument ARG.
@end defun
@defun org-priority &optional action
Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
possible values for ACTION.
@end defun
@defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
@end defun
@defun org-promote
Promote the current entry.
@end defun
@defun org-demote
Demote the current entry.
@end defun
Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
2008-06-15 03:44:21 -04:00
a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
@lisp
(org-map-entries
'(org-todo "UPCOMING")
"+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
@end lisp
The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
@code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
@lisp
2008-12-02 10:53:25 -05:00
(length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@end lisp
2008-05-28 00:44:06 -04:00
@node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, Hacking, Top
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@appendix History and Acknowledgments
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex acknowledgments
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@cindex history
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@cindex thanks
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
Org was borne in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface
of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However,
having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
constantly want to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure
editing} were originally implemented in the package
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
@file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project
planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{time
stamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlight the two main
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
goals that Org still has today: To create a new, outline-based,
2008-01-31 05:33:51 -05:00
plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to
incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
A special thanks goes to @i{Bastien Guerry} who has not only writen a large
number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now),
2008-04-23 01:48:22 -04:00
but has also helped the development and maintenance of Org so much that he
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
should be considered co-author of this package.
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or on
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
let me know.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@itemize @bullet
2008-01-31 05:33:00 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@item
@i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-04-24 04:29:47 -04:00
@i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-06-16 10:26:30 -04:00
@i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
Org-mode website.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding time stamps.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
for Remember.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
specified time.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for lisp forms into table
calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
@file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Sacha Chua} suggested to copy some linking code from Planner.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
them.
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:46 -05:00
@i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
2008-01-31 05:31:11 -05:00
@item
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
HTML agendas.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
2008-01-31 05:30:30 -05:00
@item
2008-02-05 14:11:18 -05:00
@i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:32 -05:00
@i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
around a match in a hidden outline tree.
@item
2008-01-31 05:36:57 -05:00
@i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
2008-04-24 04:29:47 -04:00
@i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and @file{org-bibtex.el}, and
has been prolific with patches, ideas, and bug reports.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
been critical when we started to adopt the GIT version control system.
@item
2008-07-26 10:12:03 -04:00
@i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixed and
patches.
@item
2008-04-24 04:29:47 -04:00
@i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:03 -05:00
@i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
folded entries, and column view for properties.
@item
2008-04-24 04:29:47 -04:00
@i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
@item
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
provided frequent feedback and some patches.
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@item
2008-12-31 12:22:46 -05:00
@i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
@item
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
@item
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
@item
2008-01-31 05:34:38 -05:00
@i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
basis.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
happy.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:38:07 -05:00
@i{Rick Moynihan} proposed to allow multiple TODO sequences in a file
and to be able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
2008-01-31 05:34:09 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and elisp forms.
2008-01-31 05:31:51 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
file links, and TAGS.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:37 -05:00
@i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
into Japanese.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
links, among other things.
2008-01-31 05:29:47 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
@i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
provided frequent feedback.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
control.
@item
2008-12-31 03:25:07 -05:00
@i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-04-09 07:49:51 -04:00
@i{Sebastian Rose} wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
webpages derived from Org using an Info-like, or a folding interface with
single key navigation.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
conflict with @file{allout.el}.
2008-01-31 05:31:15 -05:00
@item
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
@i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for orgtbl tables with
extensive patches.
2008-01-31 05:32:35 -05:00
@item
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
@i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
2008-06-17 06:35:24 -04:00
of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
other things.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-09-16 10:52:21 -04:00
@i{Eric Schulte} wrote @file{org-plot.el}.
@item
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@file{organizer-mode.el}.
@item
2008-12-26 17:49:57 -05:00
@i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
2008-12-31 12:22:46 -05:00
examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
2008-04-08 06:29:28 -04:00
@item
2008-11-15 01:51:24 -05:00
@i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
@i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
subtrees.
@item
2008-01-31 05:32:45 -05:00
@i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
@item
2008-07-26 10:12:03 -04:00
@i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
tweaks and features.
@item
2008-06-11 17:27:22 -04:00
@i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
2008-01-31 05:35:40 -05:00
@item
2008-11-26 03:36:18 -05:00
@i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
with links transformation to Org syntax.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:59 -05:00
@i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
chapter about publishing.
2008-01-31 05:31:31 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
in HTML output.
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
keyword.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
system.
@item
2008-05-05 03:13:25 -04:00
@i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el}, @file{planner.el}, and
2008-06-16 10:26:30 -04:00
@file{muse.el}, which have similar goals as Org. Initially the
development of Org was fully independent because I was not aware of the
existence of these packages. But with time I have accasionally looked
at John's code and learned a lot from it. John has also contributed a
2008-10-01 03:25:18 -04:00
number of great ideas and patches directly to Org, including the attachment
system (@file{org-attach.el}) and integration with Apple Mail
2008-10-01 05:54:33 -04:00
(@file{org-mac-message.el}).
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-01-31 05:31:55 -05:00
@i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
linking to Gnus.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@item
2008-03-30 17:59:57 -04:00
@i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
work on a tty.
@item
2008-01-31 05:33:05 -05:00
@i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
2008-01-31 05:32:32 -05:00
and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end itemize
2008-01-31 05:32:08 -05:00
2008-01-31 05:38:30 -05:00
@node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
2008-01-31 05:38:26 -05:00
@unnumbered The Main Index
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@printindex cp
2008-01-31 05:38:30 -05:00
@node Key Index, , Main Index, Top
2008-01-31 05:32:28 -05:00
@unnumbered Key Index
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@printindex ky
@bye
@ignore
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
2008-01-31 04:30:03 -05:00
@end ignore
2008-03-30 10:19:45 -04:00
@c Local variables:
@c ispell-local-dictionary: "en_US-w_accents"
@c ispell-local-pdict: "./.aspell.org.pws"
@c fill-column: 77
@c End:
2008-06-22 23:45:48 -04:00